From 223b99165a249d77c1658eff8ce2262875170ec9 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: Florian Allmann-Rahn Date: Sun, 15 Apr 2012 17:50:21 +0200 Subject: translated or removed german comments in connectivity, cppuhelper and cui --- connectivity/source/commontools/dbconversion.cxx | 12 +- connectivity/source/drivers/calc/CTable.cxx | 4 +- connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/DIndexIter.cxx | 2 +- connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/dindexnode.cxx | 4 +- connectivity/source/drivers/jdbc/Array.cxx | 2 +- .../source/drivers/mozab/MResultSetMetaData.hxx | 2 +- .../source/drivers/odbcbase/OConnection.cxx | 4 +- .../source/drivers/odbcbase/OResultSet.cxx | 4 +- connectivity/source/inc/file/FTable.hxx | 4 +- connectivity/source/inc/flat/EConnection.hxx | 6 +- connectivity/source/inc/java/io/InputStream.hxx | 2 +- cppuhelper/source/propshlp.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/customize/cfgutil.cxx | 41 ++-- cui/source/customize/macropg.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/customize/selector.cxx | 7 - cui/source/dialogs/SpellDialog.cxx | 20 +- cui/source/dialogs/cuifmsearch.cxx | 85 ++++---- cui/source/dialogs/cuigaldlg.cxx | 6 +- cui/source/dialogs/dlgname.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/hlmarkwn.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/hyphen.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/iconcdlg.cxx | 21 +- cui/source/dialogs/insdlg.cxx | 8 +- cui/source/dialogs/linkdlg.cxx | 41 ++-- cui/source/dialogs/pastedlg.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/plfilter.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/postdlg.cxx | 4 +- cui/source/dialogs/scriptdlg.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/thesdlg.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/dialogs/zoom.cxx | 14 +- cui/source/inc/autocdlg.hxx | 4 +- cui/source/inc/backgrnd.hxx | 6 +- cui/source/inc/bbdlg.hxx | 2 +- cui/source/inc/connect.hxx | 6 +- cui/source/inc/cuifmsearch.hxx | 65 +++--- cui/source/inc/cuitabarea.hxx | 22 +-- cui/source/inc/cuitabline.hxx | 4 +- cui/source/inc/gallery.hrc | 6 +- cui/source/inc/iconcdlg.hxx | 43 ++-- cui/source/inc/macroass.hxx | 4 +- cui/source/inc/macropg.hxx | 2 +- cui/source/inc/measure.hxx | 6 +- cui/source/inc/numfmt.hxx | 2 +- cui/source/inc/numpages.hxx | 8 +- cui/source/inc/page.hxx | 8 +- cui/source/inc/paragrph.hxx | 30 +-- cui/source/inc/postdlg.hxx | 8 +- cui/source/inc/tabstpge.hxx | 12 +- cui/source/inc/textanim.hxx | 2 +- cui/source/inc/textattr.hxx | 2 +- cui/source/inc/transfrm.hxx | 4 +- cui/source/options/dbregister.cxx | 4 +- cui/source/options/fontsubs.cxx | 12 +- cui/source/options/optHeaderTabListbox.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/options/optdict.cxx | 30 +-- cui/source/options/optfltr.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/options/optgenrl.cxx | 6 +- cui/source/options/optgenrl.hrc | 2 +- cui/source/options/opthtml.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/options/optinet2.cxx | 2 +- cui/source/options/optlingu.cxx | 12 +- cui/source/options/optmemory.cxx | 2 - cui/source/options/optpath.cxx | 4 +- cui/source/options/optsave.cxx | 4 +- cui/source/options/treeopt.cxx | 24 +-- cui/source/tabpages/autocdlg.cxx | 84 ++++---- cui/source/tabpages/backgrnd.cxx | 162 +++++++-------- cui/source/tabpages/border.cxx | 58 +++--- cui/source/tabpages/border.hrc | 2 +- cui/source/tabpages/chardlg.cxx | 29 ++- cui/source/tabpages/connect.cxx | 14 +- cui/source/tabpages/grfpage.cxx | 40 ++-- cui/source/tabpages/labdlg.cxx | 26 ++- cui/source/tabpages/macroass.cxx | 15 +- cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.cxx | 217 ++++++++++----------- cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.hrc | 2 +- cui/source/tabpages/numpages.cxx | 88 ++++----- cui/source/tabpages/page.cxx | 124 ++++++------ cui/source/tabpages/paragrph.cxx | 74 ++++--- cui/source/tabpages/swpossizetabpage.cxx | 40 ++-- cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.cxx | 18 +- cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.hrc | 4 +- cui/source/tabpages/textanim.cxx | 28 +-- cui/source/tabpages/textattr.cxx | 30 ++- cui/source/tabpages/tparea.cxx | 99 +++++----- cui/source/tabpages/tpbitmap.cxx | 72 +++---- cui/source/tabpages/tpcolor.cxx | 85 ++++---- cui/source/tabpages/tpgradnt.cxx | 81 ++++---- cui/source/tabpages/tphatch.cxx | 64 +++--- cui/source/tabpages/tpline.cxx | 4 +- cui/source/tabpages/tplnedef.cxx | 64 +++--- cui/source/tabpages/tplneend.cxx | 46 ++--- cui/source/tabpages/tpshadow.cxx | 59 +++--- cui/source/tabpages/transfrm.cxx | 22 +-- 94 files changed, 1072 insertions(+), 1244 deletions(-) diff --git a/connectivity/source/commontools/dbconversion.cxx b/connectivity/source/commontools/dbconversion.cxx index 7c6f10de28b8..2e31620029ad 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/commontools/dbconversion.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/commontools/dbconversion.cxx @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ namespace dbtools //------------------------------------------------------------------------------ sal_Int32 DBTypeConversion::toINT32(const Time& rVal) { - // Zeit normalisieren + // normalize time sal_Int32 nSeconds = rVal.Seconds + rVal.HundredthSeconds / 100; sal_Int32 nHundredthSeconds = rVal.HundredthSeconds % 100; sal_Int32 nMinutes = rVal.Minutes + nSeconds / 60; @@ -141,14 +141,14 @@ namespace dbtools sal_Int32 nHours = rVal.Hours + nMinutes / 60; nMinutes = nMinutes % 60; - // Zeit zusammenbauen + // assemble time return (sal_Int32)(nHundredthSeconds + (nSeconds*100) + (nMinutes*10000) + (nHours*1000000)); } //------------------------------------------------------------------------------ sal_Int64 DBTypeConversion::toINT64(const DateTime& rVal) { - // Zeit normalisieren + // normalize time sal_Int32 nSeconds = rVal.Seconds + rVal.HundredthSeconds / 100; sal_Int32 nHundredthSeconds = rVal.HundredthSeconds % 100; sal_Int32 nMinutes = rVal.Minutes + nSeconds / 60; @@ -156,7 +156,7 @@ namespace dbtools sal_Int32 nHours = rVal.Hours + nMinutes / 60; nMinutes = nMinutes % 60; - // Zeit zusammenbauen + // assemble time sal_Int32 nTime = (sal_Int32)(nHundredthSeconds + (nSeconds*100) + (nMinutes*10000) + (nHours*1000000)); sal_Int32 nDate = ((sal_Int32)(rVal.Day%100)) + (((sal_Int32)(rVal.Month%100))*100) + (((sal_Int32) rVal.Year%10000)*10000); sal_Int64 nRet; @@ -369,7 +369,7 @@ namespace dbtools nSign = 1; Time xRet; - // Zeit normalisieren + // normalize time // we have to sal_Int32 here because otherwise we get an overflow sal_Int32 nHundredthSeconds = nMS/10; sal_Int32 nSeconds = nHundredthSeconds / 100; @@ -380,7 +380,7 @@ namespace dbtools xRet.Hours = (sal_uInt16)(nMinutes / 60); xRet.Minutes = (sal_uInt16)(nMinutes % 60); - // Zeit zusammenbauen + // assemble time sal_Int32 nTime = (sal_Int32)(xRet.HundredthSeconds + (xRet.Seconds*100) + (xRet.Minutes*10000) + (xRet.Hours*1000000)) * nSign; if(nTime < 0) diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/calc/CTable.cxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/calc/CTable.cxx index b4b841a01b4d..c1bfc587ccb0 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/calc/CTable.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/calc/CTable.cxx @@ -749,7 +749,7 @@ sal_Bool OCalcTable::seekRow(IResultSetHelper::Movement eCursorPosition, sal_Int { RTL_LOGFILE_CONTEXT_AUTHOR( aLogger, "calc", "Ocke.Janssen@sun.com", "OCalcTable::seekRow" ); // ---------------------------------------------------------- - // Positionierung vorbereiten: + // prepare positioning: sal_uInt32 nNumberOfRecords = m_nDataRows; sal_uInt32 nTempPos = m_nFilePos; @@ -808,7 +808,7 @@ Error: m_nFilePos = 0; break; case IResultSetHelper::BOOKMARK: - m_nFilePos = nTempPos; // vorherige Position + m_nFilePos = nTempPos; // previous position } // aStatus.Set(SDB_STAT_NO_DATA_FOUND); return sal_False; diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/DIndexIter.cxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/DIndexIter.cxx index 1f86d3d55e31..546daecd8299 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/DIndexIter.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/DIndexIter.cxx @@ -256,7 +256,7 @@ sal_uIntPtr OIndexIterator::GetNotNull(sal_Bool bFirst) ONDXKey* pKey; if (bFirst) { - // erst alle NULL werte abklappern + // go through all NULL values first for (sal_uIntPtr nRec = GetNull(bFirst); nRec != STRING_NOTFOUND; nRec = GetNull(sal_False)) diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/dindexnode.cxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/dindexnode.cxx index d0e9f5ae19c5..e04ec3deefce 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/dindexnode.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/dbase/dindexnode.cxx @@ -75,7 +75,7 @@ ONDXKey::ONDXKey(double aVal, sal_uInt32 nRec) // ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- //================================================================== -// Index Seite +// index page //================================================================== ONDXPage::ONDXPage(ODbaseIndex& rInd, sal_uInt32 nPos, ONDXPage* pParent) :nPagePos(nPos) @@ -204,7 +204,7 @@ sal_Bool ONDXPage::Insert(ONDXNode& rNode, sal_uInt32 nRowsLeft) --nCount; // (otherwise we might get Assertions and GPFs - 60593) bResult = Insert(rIndex.m_nCurNode + 1, rNode); } - else // Position unbekannt + else // position unknown { sal_uInt16 nPos = NODE_NOTFOUND; while (++nPos < nCount && rNode.GetKey() > ((*this)[nPos]).GetKey()) ; diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/jdbc/Array.cxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/jdbc/Array.cxx index 71abde00cacc..d7ccb2a277b9 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/jdbc/Array.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/jdbc/Array.cxx @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ sal_Int32 SAL_CALL java_sql_Array::getBaseType( ) throw(::com::sun::star::sdbc: // initialize temporary variable static const char * cSignature = "(Ljava/util/Map;)Ljava/sql/ResultSet;"; static const char * cMethodName = "getResultSetAtIndex"; - // Java-Call absetzen + // submit Java-Call static jmethodID mID(NULL); obtainMethodId(t.pEnv, cMethodName,cSignature, mID); t.pEnv->CallObjectMethod( object, mID, index,count,obj); diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/mozab/MResultSetMetaData.hxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/mozab/MResultSetMetaData.hxx index e04668070dfc..71ecad1074e1 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/mozab/MResultSetMetaData.hxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/mozab/MResultSetMetaData.hxx @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ namespace connectivity protected: virtual ~OResultSetMetaData(); public: - // ein Konstruktor, der fuer das Returnen des Objektes benoetigt wird: + // a constructor that is needed to return the object: // OResultSetMetaData(OConnection* _pConnection) : m_pConnection(_pConnection){} OResultSetMetaData(const ::rtl::Reference& _rxColumns, const ::rtl::OUString& _aTableName,OTable* _pTable,sal_Bool aReadOnly diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OConnection.cxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OConnection.cxx index 323e9d2e44ee..b206ab481db8 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OConnection.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OConnection.cxx @@ -122,7 +122,6 @@ SQLRETURN OConnection::OpenConnection(const ::rtl::OUString& aConnectStr,sal_Int #ifndef MACOSX N3SQLSetConnectAttr(m_aConnectionHandle,SQL_ATTR_LOGIN_TIMEOUT,(SQLPOINTER)(sal_IntPtr)nTimeOut,SQL_IS_UINTEGER); - // Verbindung aufbauen #endif #ifdef LINUX @@ -176,7 +175,7 @@ SQLRETURN OConnection::OpenConnection(const ::rtl::OUString& aConnectStr,sal_Int } - // autocoomit ist immer default + // autocoomit is always default if (!m_bReadOnly) N3SQLSetConnectAttr(m_aConnectionHandle,SQL_ATTR_AUTOCOMMIT,(SQLPOINTER)SQL_AUTOCOMMIT_ON,SQL_IS_INTEGER); @@ -190,7 +189,6 @@ SQLRETURN OConnection::Construct(const ::rtl::OUString& url,const Sequence< Prop m_sURL = url; setConnectionInfo(info); - // Connection allozieren N3SQLAllocHandle(SQL_HANDLE_DBC,m_pDriverHandleCopy,&m_aConnectionHandle); if(m_aConnectionHandle == SQL_NULL_HANDLE) throw SQLException(); diff --git a/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OResultSet.cxx b/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OResultSet.cxx index a882c2140b6d..43f96161d5a8 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OResultSet.cxx +++ b/connectivity/source/drivers/odbcbase/OResultSet.cxx @@ -285,11 +285,11 @@ TVoidPtr OResultSet::allocBindColumn(sal_Int32 _nType,sal_Int32 _nColumnIndex) break; case DataType::LONGVARCHAR: case DataType::CLOB: - aPair = TVoidPtr(reinterpret_cast< sal_Int64 >(new char[2]),_nType); // dient nur zum auffinden + aPair = TVoidPtr(reinterpret_cast< sal_Int64 >(new char[2]),_nType); // only for finding break; case DataType::LONGVARBINARY: case DataType::BLOB: - aPair = TVoidPtr(reinterpret_cast< sal_Int64 >(new char[2]),_nType); // dient nur zum auffinden + aPair = TVoidPtr(reinterpret_cast< sal_Int64 >(new char[2]),_nType); // only for finding break; case DataType::DATE: aPair = TVoidPtr(reinterpret_cast< sal_Int64 >(new DATE_STRUCT),_nType); diff --git a/connectivity/source/inc/file/FTable.hxx b/connectivity/source/inc/file/FTable.hxx index 23a1086234f9..17224fad624b 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/inc/file/FTable.hxx +++ b/connectivity/source/inc/file/FTable.hxx @@ -50,9 +50,9 @@ namespace connectivity OConnection* m_pConnection; SvStream* m_pFileStream; ::rtl::Reference m_aColumns; - sal_Int32 m_nFilePos; // aktuelle IResultSetHelper::Movement + sal_Int32 m_nFilePos; // current IResultSetHelper::Movement sal_uInt8* m_pBuffer; - sal_uInt16 m_nBufferSize; // Groesse des ReadBuffer, wenn pBuffer != NULL + sal_uInt16 m_nBufferSize; // size of the ReadBuffer, if pBuffer != NULL sal_Bool m_bWriteable; // svstream cann't say if we are writeable // so we have to diff --git a/connectivity/source/inc/flat/EConnection.hxx b/connectivity/source/inc/flat/EConnection.hxx index 23c4d4006d47..986812ac8321 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/inc/flat/EConnection.hxx +++ b/connectivity/source/inc/flat/EConnection.hxx @@ -42,9 +42,9 @@ namespace connectivity sal_Int32 m_nMaxRowsToScan; sal_Bool m_bHeaderLine; // column names in first row sal_Unicode m_cFieldDelimiter; // look at the name - sal_Unicode m_cStringDelimiter; // delimiter for strings m_cStringDelimiter blabla m_cStringDelimiter - sal_Unicode m_cDecimalDelimiter; // Dezimal-delimiter (Dezimalpoint) - sal_Unicode m_cThousandDelimiter; // + sal_Unicode m_cStringDelimiter; + sal_Unicode m_cDecimalDelimiter; + sal_Unicode m_cThousandDelimiter; public: OFlatConnection(ODriver* _pDriver); virtual ~OFlatConnection(); diff --git a/connectivity/source/inc/java/io/InputStream.hxx b/connectivity/source/inc/java/io/InputStream.hxx index 889408f7c40d..c1f60b703142 100644 --- a/connectivity/source/inc/java/io/InputStream.hxx +++ b/connectivity/source/inc/java/io/InputStream.hxx @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ namespace connectivity public ::cppu::WeakImplHelper1< ::com::sun::star::io::XInputStream> { protected: - // statische Data for the class + // static Data for the Class static jclass theClass; virtual ~java_io_InputStream(); public: diff --git a/cppuhelper/source/propshlp.cxx b/cppuhelper/source/propshlp.cxx index 9c5610feded2..f1ce426ec64a 100644 --- a/cppuhelper/source/propshlp.cxx +++ b/cppuhelper/source/propshlp.cxx @@ -86,7 +86,7 @@ class OPropertySetHelperInfo_Impl public: OPropertySetHelperInfo_Impl( IPropertyArrayHelper & rHelper_ ) SAL_THROW(()); - // XPropertySetInfo-Methoden + // XPropertySetInfo-methods virtual Sequence< Property > SAL_CALL getProperties(void) throw(::com::sun::star::uno::RuntimeException); virtual Property SAL_CALL getPropertyByName(const OUString& PropertyName) throw(::com::sun::star::beans::UnknownPropertyException, ::com::sun::star::uno::RuntimeException); virtual sal_Bool SAL_CALL hasPropertyByName(const OUString& PropertyName) throw(::com::sun::star::uno::RuntimeException); diff --git a/cui/source/customize/cfgutil.cxx b/cui/source/customize/cfgutil.cxx index 9b0cf6782a5e..932b1fb1c0e6 100644 --- a/cui/source/customize/cfgutil.cxx +++ b/cui/source/customize/cfgutil.cxx @@ -293,10 +293,10 @@ void SfxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl::MouseMove( const MouseEvent& ) } IMPL_LINK( SfxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl, TimerHdl, Timer*, pTimer) -/* Beschreibung - Timer-Handler f"ur die Einblendung eines Hilfetextes. Wenn nach Ablauf des Timers - der Mauszeiger immer noch auf dem aktuell selektierten Eintrag steht, wird der - Helptext des Entries als Balloon-Help eingeblendet. +/* Description + Timer-handler for showing a help-text. If the mouse pointer is + still on the currently selected entry after the timer has run out, + the entry's help-text is shown as a balloon-help. */ { (void)pTimer; // unused @@ -304,9 +304,9 @@ IMPL_LINK( SfxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl, TimerHdl, Timer*, pTimer) } void SfxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl::ClearAll() -/* Beschreibung - L"oscht alle Eintr"age in der FunctionListBox, alle UserDaten und alle evtl. - vorhandenen MacroInfos. +/* Description + Deletes all entries in the FunctionListBox, all UserData and all + possibly existing MacroInfo. */ { sal_uInt16 nCount = aArr.Count(); @@ -374,9 +374,9 @@ String SfxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl::GetCurLabel() } void SfxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl::FunctionSelected() -/* Beschreibung - Setzt die Balloonhelp zur"uck, da diese immer den Helptext des selektierten - Entry anzeigen soll. +/* Description + Resets the balloon-help because it shall + always show the help-text of the selected entry. */ { } @@ -465,9 +465,8 @@ void SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::SetStylesInfo(SfxStylesInfo_Impl* pStyles) } String SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::GetGroup() -/* Beschreibung - Gibt den Namen der selektierten Funktionsgruppe bzw. des selektierten - Basics zur"uck. +/* Description + Returns the name of the selected function group/the selected basic. */ { SvLBoxEntry *pEntry = FirstSelected(); @@ -893,9 +892,9 @@ SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::getDocumentModel( Reference< XComponentContext >& xC //----------------------------------------------- void SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::GroupSelected() -/* Beschreibung - Eine Funktionsgruppe oder eine Basicmodul wurde selektiert. Alle Funktionen bzw. - Macros werden in der Functionlistbox anzeigt. +/* Description + A function group or a basic module has been selected. + All functions/macros are displayed in the functionlistbox. */ { SvLBoxEntry *pEntry = FirstSelected(); @@ -1028,21 +1027,16 @@ sal_Bool SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::Expand( SvLBoxEntry* pParent ) sal_Bool bRet = SvTreeListBox::Expand( pParent ); if ( bRet ) { - // Wieviele Entries k"onnen angezeigt werden ? sal_uLong nEntries = GetOutputSizePixel().Height() / GetEntryHeight(); - // Wieviele Kinder sollen angezeigt werden ? sal_uLong nChildCount = GetVisibleChildCount( pParent ); - // Passen alle Kinder und der parent gleichzeitig in die View ? if ( nChildCount+1 > nEntries ) { - // Wenn nicht, wenigstens parent ganz nach oben schieben MakeVisible( pParent, sal_True ); } else { - // An welcher relativen ViewPosition steht der aufzuklappende parent SvLBoxEntry *pEntry = GetFirstEntryInView(); sal_uLong nParentPos = 0; while ( pEntry && pEntry != pParent ) @@ -1051,7 +1045,6 @@ sal_Bool SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::Expand( SvLBoxEntry* pParent ) pEntry = GetNextEntryInView( pEntry ); } - // Ist unter dem parent noch genug Platz f"ur alle Kinder ? if ( nParentPos + nChildCount + 1 > nEntries ) ScrollOutputArea( (short)( nEntries - ( nParentPos + nChildCount + 1 ) ) ); } @@ -1061,8 +1054,8 @@ sal_Bool SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::Expand( SvLBoxEntry* pParent ) } void SfxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::RequestingChildren( SvLBoxEntry *pEntry ) -/* Beschreibung - Ein Basic oder eine Bibliothek werden ge"offnet +/* Description + A basic or a library is opened. */ { SfxGroupInfo_Impl *pInfo = (SfxGroupInfo_Impl*) pEntry->GetUserData(); diff --git a/cui/source/customize/macropg.cxx b/cui/source/customize/macropg.cxx index 6f8b8d5b1aa4..94719ff6bec9 100644 --- a/cui/source/customize/macropg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/customize/macropg.cxx @@ -90,7 +90,7 @@ _SvxMacroTabPage_Impl::~_SvxMacroTabPage_Impl() delete pEventLB; } -// Achtung im Code wird dieses Array direkt (0, 1, ...) indiziert +// attention, this array is indexed directly (0, 1, ...) in the code static long nTabs[] = { 2, // Number of Tabs diff --git a/cui/source/customize/selector.cxx b/cui/source/customize/selector.cxx index 6343692a850c..21b5e61858a3 100644 --- a/cui/source/customize/selector.cxx +++ b/cui/source/customize/selector.cxx @@ -153,7 +153,6 @@ void SvxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl::ClearAll() String SvxConfigFunctionListBox_Impl::GetHelpText( SvLBoxEntry *pEntry ) { - // Information zum selektierten Entry aus den Userdaten holen SvxGroupInfo_Impl *pInfo = pEntry ? (SvxGroupInfo_Impl*) pEntry->GetUserData(): 0; @@ -864,21 +863,16 @@ sal_Bool SvxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::Expand( SvLBoxEntry* pParent ) sal_Bool bRet = SvTreeListBox::Expand( pParent ); if ( bRet ) { - // Wieviele Entries k"onnen angezeigt werden ? sal_uLong nEntries = GetOutputSizePixel().Height() / GetEntryHeight(); - // Wieviele Kinder sollen angezeigt werden ? sal_uLong nChildCount = GetVisibleChildCount( pParent ); - // Passen alle Kinder und der parent gleichzeitig in die View ? if ( nChildCount+1 > nEntries ) { - // Wenn nicht, wenigstens parent ganz nach oben schieben MakeVisible( pParent, sal_True ); } else { - // An welcher relativen ViewPosition steht der aufzuklappende parent SvLBoxEntry *pEntry = GetFirstEntryInView(); sal_uLong nParentPos = 0; while ( pEntry && pEntry != pParent ) @@ -887,7 +881,6 @@ sal_Bool SvxConfigGroupListBox_Impl::Expand( SvLBoxEntry* pParent ) pEntry = GetNextEntryInView( pEntry ); } - // Ist unter dem parent noch genug Platz f"ur alle Kinder ? if ( nParentPos + nChildCount + 1 > nEntries ) ScrollOutputArea( (short)( nEntries - ( nParentPos + nChildCount + 1 ) ) ); } diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/SpellDialog.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/SpellDialog.cxx index 23b3aa4ddaf8..04f8185cd716 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/SpellDialog.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/SpellDialog.cxx @@ -308,7 +308,7 @@ SpellDialog::~SpellDialog() void SpellDialog::Init_Impl() { - // Handler initialisieren + // initialize handler aClosePB.SetClickHdl(LINK( this, SpellDialog, CancelHdl ) ); aChangePB.SetClickHdl(LINK( this, SpellDialog, ChangeHdl ) ); aChangeAllPB.SetClickHdl(LINK( this, SpellDialog, ChangeAllHdl ) ); @@ -368,7 +368,7 @@ void SpellDialog::UpdateBoxes_Impl() SetSelectedLang_Impl( nAltLanguage ); InitUserDicts(); - // Alternativen eintragen + // enter alternatives const ::rtl::OUString *pNewWords = aNewWords.getConstArray(); const sal_Int32 nSize = aNewWords.getLength(); for ( i = 0; i < nSize; ++i ) @@ -620,8 +620,6 @@ void SpellDialog::StartSpellOptDlg_Impl() pDlg->SetTabPage( pPage ); if(RET_OK == pDlg->Execute()) { - - // Benutzerb"ucher anzeigen InitUserDicts(); const SfxItemSet* pOutSet = pDlg->GetOutputItemSet(); if(pOutSet) @@ -888,17 +886,13 @@ IMPL_LINK(SpellDialog, LanguageSelectHdl, SvxLanguageBox*, pBox) // ----------------------------------------------------------------------- void SpellDialog::SetLanguage( sal_uInt16 nLang ) - -/* [Beschreibung] - - wenn die Sprache im Thesaurus umgestellt wurde, - muss auch hier die Sprache umgestellt werden. +/* + Description: + If the language has been changed in thesaurus, + it must be changed here, too. */ - { SetTitle_Impl( nLang ); - - // den richtigen Eintrag finden, da sortiert aLanguageLB.SelectLanguage( nLang ); } @@ -1050,7 +1044,7 @@ IMPL_LINK(SpellDialog, AddToDictionaryHdl, MenuButton*, pButton ) if (DIC_ERR_NONE != nAddRes) { SvxDicError( this, nAddRes ); - return 0; // Nicht weitermachen + return 0; // don't continue } // go on diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/cuifmsearch.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/cuifmsearch.cxx index 2d28672ad525..db1b7f8069f7 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/cuifmsearch.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/cuifmsearch.cxx @@ -135,7 +135,6 @@ FmSearchDialog::FmSearchDialog(Window* pParent, const UniString& sInitialText, c { DBG_ASSERT(m_lnkContextSupplier.IsSet(), "FmSearchDialog::FmSearchDialog : have no ContextSupplier !"); - // erst mal die Informationen fuer den initialen Kontext FmSearchContext fmscInitial; fmscInitial.nContext = nInitialContext; m_lnkContextSupplier.Call(&fmscInitial); @@ -345,18 +344,17 @@ IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnClickedFieldRadios, Button*, pButton) IMPL_LINK_NOARG(FmSearchDialog, OnClickedSearchAgain) { if (m_pbClose.IsEnabled()) - { // der Button hat die Funktion 'Suchen' + { // the button has the function 'search' UniString strThisRoundText = m_cmbSearchText.GetText(); - // zur History dazu + // to history m_cmbSearchText.RemoveEntry(strThisRoundText); m_cmbSearchText.InsertEntry(strThisRoundText, 0); - // das Remove/Insert stellt a) sicher, dass der UniString nicht zweimal auftaucht, b), dass die zuletzt gesuchten Strings am - // Anfang stehen - // und die Listenlaenge beschraenken + // the remove/insert makes sure that a) the UniString does not appear twice and + // that b) the last searched strings are at the beginning and limit the list length while (m_cmbSearchText.GetEntryCount() > MAX_HISTORY_ENTRIES) m_cmbSearchText.RemoveEntry(m_cmbSearchText.GetEntryCount()-1); - // den 'Ueberlauf'-Hint rausnehmen + // take out the 'overflow' hint m_ftHint.SetText(UniString()); m_ftHint.Invalidate(); @@ -379,11 +377,11 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(FmSearchDialog, OnClickedSearchAgain) } } else - { // der Button hat die Fukntion 'Abbrechen' + { // the button has the function 'cancel' DBG_ASSERT(m_pSearchEngine->GetSearchMode() != SM_BRUTE, "FmSearchDialog, OnClickedSearchAgain : falscher Modus !"); - // der CancelButton wird normalerweise nur disabled, wenn ich in einem Thread oder mit Reschedule arbeite + // the CancelButton is usually only disabled, when working in a thread or with reschedule m_pSearchEngine->CancelSearch(); - // mein ProgressHandler wird gerufen, wenn es wirklich zu Ende ist, das hier war nur eine Anforderung + // the ProgressHandler is called when it's really finished, here it's only a demand } return 0; } @@ -464,7 +462,7 @@ IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnFieldSelected, ListBox*, pBox) DBG_ASSERT(pBox->GetSelectEntryCount() == 1, "FmSearchDialog::OnFieldSelected : unerwartet : nicht genau ein Eintrag selektiert !"); m_pSearchEngine->RebuildUsedFields(m_rbAllFields.IsChecked() ? -1 : (sal_Int16)m_lbField.GetSelectEntryPos()); - // ruft auch m_pSearchEngine->InvalidatePreviousLoc auf + // calls m_pSearchEngine->InvalidatePreviousLoc too sal_Int32 nCurrentContext = m_lbForm.GetSelectEntryPos(); if (nCurrentContext != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND) @@ -477,21 +475,20 @@ IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled, CheckBox*, pBox) { sal_Bool bChecked = pBox->IsChecked(); - // Formatter oder case -> an die Engine weiterreichen + // formatter or case -> pass on to the engine if (pBox == &m_cbUseFormat) m_pSearchEngine->SetFormatterUsing(bChecked); else if (pBox == &m_cbCase) m_pSearchEngine->SetCaseSensitive(bChecked); - // Richtung -> weiterreichen und Checkbox-Text fuer StartOver neu setzen + // direction -> pass on and reset the checkbox-text for StartOver else if (pBox == &m_cbBackwards) { m_cbStartOver.SetText( String( CUI_RES( bChecked ? RID_STR_FROM_BOTTOM : RID_STR_FROM_TOP ) ) ); m_pSearchEngine->SetDirection(!bChecked); } - // Aehnlichkeitssuche oder regulaerer Ausdruck + // similarity-search or regular expression else if ((pBox == &m_cbApprox) || (pBox == &m_cbRegular) || (pBox == &m_cbWildCard)) { - // die beiden jeweils anderen Boxes disablen oder enablen CheckBox* pBoxes[] = { &m_cbWildCard, &m_cbRegular, &m_cbApprox }; for (sal_uInt32 i=0; i< SAL_N_ELEMENTS(pBoxes); ++i) { @@ -504,13 +501,13 @@ IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled, CheckBox*, pBox) } } - // an die Engine weiterreichen + // pass on to the engine m_pSearchEngine->SetWildcard(m_cbWildCard.IsEnabled() ? m_cbWildCard.IsChecked() : sal_False); m_pSearchEngine->SetRegular(m_cbRegular.IsEnabled() ? m_cbRegular.IsChecked() : sal_False); m_pSearchEngine->SetLevenshtein(m_cbApprox.IsEnabled() ? m_cbApprox.IsChecked() : sal_False); - // (Boxes, die disabled sind, muessen als sal_False an die Engine gehen) + // (disabled boxes have to be passed to the engine as sal_False) - // die Position-Listbox anpassen (ist bei Wildcard-Suche nicht erlaubt) + // adjust the Position-Listbox (which is not allowed during Wildcard-search) if (pBox == &m_cbWildCard) { if (bChecked) @@ -525,7 +522,7 @@ IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled, CheckBox*, pBox) } } - // und den Button fuer die Aehnlichkeitssuche + // and the button for similarity-search if (pBox == &m_cbApprox) { if (bChecked) @@ -570,7 +567,7 @@ void FmSearchDialog::InitContext(sal_Int16 nContext) m_lnkContextSupplier.Call(&fmscContext); DBG_ASSERT(nResult > 0, "FmSearchDialog::InitContext : ContextSupplier didn't give me any controls !"); - // packen wir zuerst die Feld-Namen in die entsprechende Listbox + // put teh field names into the respective listbox m_lbField.Clear(); if (fmscContext.sFieldDisplayNames.Len() != 0) @@ -599,11 +596,9 @@ void FmSearchDialog::InitContext(sal_Int16 nContext) m_lbField.GrabFocus(); } - // dann geben wir der Engine Bescheid m_pSearchEngine->SwitchToContext(fmscContext.xCursor, fmscContext.strUsedFields, fmscContext.arrFields, m_rbAllFields.IsChecked() ? -1 : 0); - // und die Position des neuen Cursors anzeigen m_ftRecord.SetText(String::CreateFromInt32(fmscContext.xCursor->getRow())); } @@ -617,17 +612,17 @@ IMPL_LINK( FmSearchDialog, OnContextSelection, ListBox*, pBox) //------------------------------------------------------------------------ void FmSearchDialog::EnableSearchUI(sal_Bool bEnable) { - // wenn die Controls disabled werden sollen, schalte ich mal eben kurz ihr Paint aus und verzoegert wieder an + // when the controls shall be disabled their paint is turned off and then turned on again after a delay if (!bEnable) EnableControlPaint(sal_False); else - { // beim Enablen teste ich, ob der Timer fuer das delayed paint aktiv ist und stoppe ihn wenn noetig + { if (m_aDelayedPaint.IsActive()) m_aDelayedPaint.Stop(); } - // (das ganze geht unten noch weiter) - // diese kleine Verrenkung fuehrt hoffentlich dazu, dass es nicht flackert, wenn man die SearchUI schnell hintereinander - // aus- und wieder einschaltet (wie das bei einem kurzen Suchvorgang zwangslaeufig der Fall ist) + // (the whole thing goes on below) + // this small intricateness hopfully leads to no flickering when turning the SearchUI off + // and on again shortly after (like it's the case during a short search process) if ( !bEnable ) { @@ -639,11 +634,10 @@ void FmSearchDialog::EnableSearchUI(sal_Bool bEnable) m_pPreSearchFocus = NULL; } - // der Suchen-Button hat einen Doppelfunktion, seinen Text entsprechend anpassen + // the search button has two functions -> adjust its text accordingly String sButtonText( bEnable ? m_sSearch : m_sCancel ); m_pbSearchAgain.SetText( sButtonText ); - // jetzt Controls en- oder disablen if (m_pSearchEngine->GetSearchMode() != SM_BRUTE) { m_flSearchFor.Enable (bEnable); @@ -670,7 +664,6 @@ void FmSearchDialog::EnableSearchUI(sal_Bool bEnable) } } - // und den Rest fuer das delayed paint if (!bEnable) m_aDelayedPaint.Start(); else @@ -750,19 +743,17 @@ void FmSearchDialog::OnFound(const ::com::sun::star::uno::Any& aCursorPos, sal_I { FmFoundRecordInformation friInfo; friInfo.nContext = m_lbForm.GetSelectEntryPos(); - // wenn ich keine Suche in Kontexten mache, steht hier was ungueltiges drin, aber dann ist es auch egal + // if I don't do a search in a context, this has an invalid value - but then it doesn't matter anyway friInfo.aPosition = aCursorPos; if (m_rbAllFields.IsChecked()) friInfo.nFieldPos = nFieldPos; else friInfo.nFieldPos = m_lbField.GetSelectEntryPos(); - // das setzt natuerlich voraus, dass ich wirklich in dem Feld gesucht habe, dass in der Listbox ausgewaehlt ist, - // genau das wird auch in RebuildUsedFields sichergestellt + // this of course implies that I have really searched in the field that is selected in the listbox, + // which is made sure in RebuildUsedFields - // dem Handler Bescheid sagen m_lnkFoundHandler.Call(&friInfo); - // und wieder Focus auf mich m_cmbSearchText.GrabFocus(); } @@ -770,8 +761,8 @@ void FmSearchDialog::OnFound(const ::com::sun::star::uno::Any& aCursorPos, sal_I IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnSearchProgress, FmSearchProgress*, pProgress) { SolarMutexGuard aGuard; - // diese eine Methode Thread-sicher machen (das ist ein Overkill, die ganze restliche Applikation dafuer zu blockieren, - // aber im Augenblick haben wir kein anderes Sicherheitskonpzept) + // make this single method thread-safe (it's an overkill to block the whole application for this, + // but we don't have another safety concept at the moment) switch (pProgress->aSearchState) { @@ -815,7 +806,7 @@ IMPL_LINK(FmSearchDialog, OnSearchProgress, FmSearchProgress*, pProgress) { FmFoundRecordInformation friInfo; friInfo.nContext = m_lbForm.GetSelectEntryPos(); - // wenn ich keine Suche in Kontexten mache, steht hier was ungueltiges drin, aber dann ist es auch egal + // if I don't do a search in a context, this has an invalid value - but then it doesn't matter anyway friInfo.aPosition = pProgress->aBookmark; m_lnkCanceledNotFoundHdl.Call(&friInfo); } @@ -837,22 +828,22 @@ void FmSearchDialog::LoadParams() for (; pHistory != pHistoryEnd; ++pHistory) m_cmbSearchText.InsertEntry( *pHistory ); - // die Einstellungen nehme ich an meinen UI-Elementen vor und rufe dann einfach den entsprechenden Change-Handler auf, - // dadurch werden die Daten an die SearchEngine weitergereicht und alle abhaengigen Enstellungen vorgenommen + // I do the settings at my UI-elements and then I simply call the respective change-handler, + // that way the data is handed on to the SearchEngine and all dependent settings are done - // aktuelles Feld + // current field sal_uInt16 nInitialField = m_lbField.GetEntryPos( String( aParams.sSingleSearchField ) ); if (nInitialField == COMBOBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND) nInitialField = 0; m_lbField.SelectEntryPos(nInitialField); LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnFieldSelected).Call(&m_lbField); - // alle/einzelnes Feld (NACH dem Selektieren des Feldes, da OnClickedFieldRadios dort einen gueltigen Eintrag erwartet) + // all fields/single field (AFTER selcting the field because OnClickedFieldRadios expects a valid value there) if (aParams.bAllFields) { m_rbSingleField.Check(sal_False); m_rbAllFields.Check(sal_True); LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnClickedFieldRadios).Call(&m_rbAllFields); - // OnClickedFieldRadios ruft auch um RebuildUsedFields + // OnClickedFieldRadios also calls to RebuildUsedFields } else { @@ -861,11 +852,10 @@ void FmSearchDialog::LoadParams() LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnClickedFieldRadios).Call(&m_rbSingleField); } - // Position im Feld m_lbPosition.SelectEntryPos(aParams.nPosition); LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnPositionSelected).Call(&m_lbPosition); - // Feld-Formatierung/Case-Sensitivitaet/Richtung + // field formatting/case sensitivity/direction m_cbUseFormat.Check(aParams.bUseFormatter); m_cbCase.Check( aParams.isCaseSensitive() ); m_cbBackwards.Check(aParams.bBackwards); @@ -878,8 +868,6 @@ void FmSearchDialog::LoadParams() LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled).Call(&m_aHalfFullFormsCJK); LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled).Call(&m_aSoundsLikeCJK); - // die drei Checkboxen fuer spezielle Sucharten - // erst mal alle ruecksetzen m_cbWildCard.Check(sal_False); m_cbRegular.Check(sal_False); m_cbApprox.Check(sal_False); @@ -887,7 +875,6 @@ void FmSearchDialog::LoadParams() LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled).Call(&m_cbRegular); LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled).Call(&m_cbApprox); - // dann die richtige setzen CheckBox* pToCheck = NULL; if (aParams.bWildcard) pToCheck = &m_cbWildCard; @@ -903,7 +890,7 @@ void FmSearchDialog::LoadParams() LINK(this, FmSearchDialog, OnCheckBoxToggled).Call(pToCheck); } - // die Levenshtein-Parameter direkt an der SearchEngine setzen + // set Levenshtein-parameters directly at the SearchEngine m_pSearchEngine->SetLevRelaxed(aParams.bLevRelaxed); m_pSearchEngine->SetLevOther(aParams.nLevOther); m_pSearchEngine->SetLevShorter(aParams.nLevShorter); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/cuigaldlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/cuigaldlg.cxx index 49b210657ff7..fd80ad33f3fd 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/cuigaldlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/cuigaldlg.cxx @@ -323,13 +323,11 @@ void TakeThread::execute() for( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < nEntries && schedule(); i++ ) { - // kompletten Filenamen aus FoundList holen if( mpBrowser->bTakeAll ) aURL = INetURLObject( *mpBrowser->aFoundList[ nPos = i ] ); else aURL = INetURLObject(*mpBrowser->aFoundList[ nPos = mpBrowser->aLbxFound.GetSelectEntryPos( i ) ]); - // Position in Taken-Liste uebernehmen mrTakenList.push_back( (sal_uLong)nPos ); { @@ -707,7 +705,7 @@ void TPGalleryThemeGeneral::SetXChgData( ExchangeData* _pData ) aFtMSShowType.SetText( aType ); aFtMSShowPath.SetText( pThm->GetSdgURL().GetMainURL( INetURLObject::DECODE_UNAMBIGUOUS ) ); - // Ein- oder Mehrzahl? + // singular or plural? if ( 1 == pThm->GetObjectCount() ) aObjStr = aObjStr.GetToken( 0 ); else @@ -728,7 +726,7 @@ void TPGalleryThemeGeneral::SetXChgData( ExchangeData* _pData ) aAccess += aLocaleData.getTime( pData->aThemeChangeTime ); aFtMSShowChangeDate.SetText( aAccess ); - // Image setzen + // set image sal_uInt16 nId; if( pThm->IsImported() ) diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/dlgname.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/dlgname.cxx index 7239b4a8d695..a742cbd9def2 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/dlgname.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/dlgname.cxx @@ -151,7 +151,7 @@ SvxObjectTitleDescDialog::SvxObjectTitleDescDialog( /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum Abbrechen, Speichern oder Hinzufuegen +|* dialog for cancelling, saving or adding |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/hlmarkwn.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/hlmarkwn.cxx index 04e90b5a5b10..e26d0435ad92 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/hlmarkwn.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/hlmarkwn.cxx @@ -141,7 +141,7 @@ SvxHlinkDlgMarkWnd::SvxHlinkDlgMarkWnd( SvxHyperlinkTabPageBase *pParent ) maBtClose.SetClickHdl ( LINK ( this, SvxHlinkDlgMarkWnd, ClickCloseHdl_Impl ) ); maLbTree.SetDoubleClickHdl ( LINK ( this, SvxHlinkDlgMarkWnd, ClickApplyHdl_Impl ) ); - // Tree-ListBox mit Linien versehen + // add lines to the Tree-ListBox maLbTree.SetStyle( maLbTree.GetStyle() | WB_TABSTOP | WB_BORDER | WB_HASLINES | WB_HASBUTTONS | //WB_HASLINESATROOT | WB_HSCROLL | WB_HASBUTTONSATROOT ); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/hyphen.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/hyphen.cxx index 35c1fd11fd3f..064231c5f086 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/hyphen.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/hyphen.cxx @@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ void HyphenEdit_Impl::KeyInput( const KeyEvent& rKEvt ) Edit::KeyInput(rKEvt); break; default: - Control::KeyInput( rKEvt ); // An den Dialog weiterleiten + Control::KeyInput( rKEvt ); // pass on to the dialog break; } } diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/iconcdlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/iconcdlg.cxx index db3fe8b055cd..8b98a6f85e42 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/iconcdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/iconcdlg.cxx @@ -499,7 +499,7 @@ void IconChoiceDialog::SetPosSizeCtrls ( sal_Bool bInit ) maIconCtrl.ArrangeIcons(); //////////////////////////////////////// - // Pages resizen & positionieren + // resize & position the pages // for ( size_t i = 0; i < maPageList.size(); i++ ) { @@ -544,7 +544,7 @@ void IconChoiceDialog::SetPosSizeCtrls ( sal_Bool bInit ) } //////////////////////////////////////// - // Buttons positionieren + // position the buttons // sal_uLong nXOffset=0; if ( meChoicePos == PosRight ) @@ -697,7 +697,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(IconChoiceDialog, ResetHdl) if ( pData->bOnDemand ) { - // CSet auf AIS hat hier Probleme, daher getrennt + // CSet on AIS has problems here, therefore seperated const SfxItemSet* _pSet = &( pData->pPage->GetItemSet() ); pData->pPage->Reset( *(SfxItemSet*)_pSet ); } @@ -829,11 +829,11 @@ sal_Bool IconChoiceDialog::DeActivatePageImpl () { pSet = GetRefreshedSet(); DBG_ASSERT( pSet, "GetRefreshedSet() liefert NULL" ); - // alle Pages als neu zu initialsieren flaggen + // flag all pages to be newly initialized for ( size_t i = 0, nCount = maPageList.size(); i < nCount; ++i ) { IconChoicePageData* pObj = maPageList[ i ]; - if ( pObj->pPage != pPage ) // eigene Page nicht mehr refreshen + if ( pObj->pPage != pPage ) pObj->bRefresh = sal_True; else pObj->bRefresh = sal_False; @@ -857,7 +857,7 @@ void IconChoiceDialog::ResetPageImpl () if ( pData->bOnDemand ) { - // CSet auf AIS hat hier Probleme, daher getrennt + // CSet on AIS has problems here, therefore seperated const SfxItemSet* _pSet = &pData->pPage->GetItemSet(); pData->pPage->Reset( *(SfxItemSet*)_pSet ); } @@ -906,7 +906,6 @@ const sal_uInt16* IconChoiceDialog::GetInputRanges( const SfxItemPool& rPool ) aUS[i] = rPool.GetWhich( aUS[i] ); } - // sortieren if ( aUS.size() > 1 ) { std::sort( aUS.begin(), aUS.end() ); @@ -1010,15 +1009,15 @@ void IconChoiceDialog::Start_Impl() else nActPage = mnCurrentPageId; - // Konfiguration vorhanden? + // configuration existing? SvtViewOptions aTabDlgOpt( E_TABDIALOG, String::CreateFromInt32( nResId ) ); if ( aTabDlgOpt.Exists() ) { - // ggf. Position aus Konfig + // possibly position from config SetWindowState(rtl::OUStringToOString(aTabDlgOpt.GetWindowState().getStr(), RTL_TEXTENCODING_ASCII_US)); - // initiale TabPage aus Programm/Hilfe/Konfig + // initial TabPage from program/help/config nActPage = (sal_uInt16)aTabDlgOpt.GetPageID(); if ( USHRT_MAX != mnCurrentPageId ) @@ -1114,7 +1113,7 @@ short IconChoiceDialog::Ok() if ( !pOutSet ) { if ( !pExampleSet && pSet ) - pOutSet = pSet->Clone( sal_False ); // ohne Items + pOutSet = pSet->Clone( sal_False ); // without items else if ( pExampleSet ) pOutSet = new SfxItemSet( *pExampleSet ); } diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/insdlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/insdlg.cxx index 5216b00f0c90..d7ccde69cfcf 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/insdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/insdlg.cxx @@ -309,7 +309,7 @@ short SvInsertOleDlg::Execute() { if( aFileName.Len() ) // from OLE Dialog { - // Objekt konnte nicht aus Datei erzeugt werden + // object couldn't be created from file // global Resource from svtools (former so3 resource) String aErr( impl_getSvtResString( STR_ERROR_OBJNOCREATE_FROM_FILE ) ); aErr.SearchAndReplace( String( '%' ), aFileName ); @@ -317,7 +317,7 @@ short SvInsertOleDlg::Execute() } else { - // Objekt konnte nicht erzeugt werden + // object couldn't be created // global Resource from svtools (former so3 resource) String aErr( impl_getSvtResString( STR_ERROR_OBJNOCREATE ) ); aErr.SearchAndReplace( String( '%' ), aServerName ); @@ -370,7 +370,7 @@ short SvInsertOleDlg::Execute() if ( !m_xObj.is() ) { - // Objekt konnte nicht aus Datei erzeugt werden + // object couldn't be created from file // global Resource from svtools (former so3 resource) String aErr( impl_getSvtResString( STR_ERROR_OBJNOCREATE_FROM_FILE ) ); aErr.SearchAndReplace( String( '%' ), aFileName ); @@ -526,7 +526,7 @@ short SvInsertPlugInDialog::Execute() } else { - // PlugIn konnte nicht erzeugt werden + // PlugIn couldn't be created // global Resource from svtools (former so3 resource) String aErr( impl_getSvtResString( STR_ERROR_OBJNOCREATE_PLUGIN ) ); aErr.SearchAndReplace( String( '%' ), aURL ); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/linkdlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/linkdlg.cxx index e6d4e5ef8630..11c714af8d76 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/linkdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/linkdlg.cxx @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ using namespace sfx2; SV_DECL_IMPL_REF_LIST(SvBaseLink,SvBaseLink*) -// Achtung im Code wird dieses Array direkt (0, 1, ...) indiziert +// attention, this array is indexed directly (0, 1, ...) in the code static long nTabs[] = { 4, // Number of Tabs 0, 77, 144, 209 @@ -109,9 +109,9 @@ SvBaseLinksDlg::SvBaseLinksDlg( Window * pParent, LinkManager* pMgr, sal_Bool bH aTbLinks.SetHelpId(HID_LINKDLG_TABLB); aTbLinks.SetSelectionMode( MULTIPLE_SELECTION ); aTbLinks.SetTabs( &nTabs[0], MAP_APPFONT ); - aTbLinks.Resize(); // OS: Hack fuer richtige Selektion + aTbLinks.Resize(); // OS: hack for correct selection - // UpdateTimer fuer DDE-/Grf-Links, auf die gewarted wird + // UpdateTimer for DDE-/Grf-links, which are waited for aUpdateTimer.SetTimeoutHdl( LINK( this, SvBaseLinksDlg, UpdateWaitingHdl ) ); aUpdateTimer.SetTimeout( 1000 ); //IAccessibility2 Implementation 2009----- @@ -150,7 +150,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvBaseLinksDlg, LinksSelectHdl, SvTabListBox *, pSvTabListBox ) (sal_uInt16)pSvTabListBox->GetSelectionCount() : 0; if(nSelectionCount > 1) { - //bei Mehrfachselektion ggf. alte Eintraege deselektieren + // possibly deselect old entries in case of multi-selection SvLBoxEntry* pEntry = 0; SvBaseLink* pLink = 0; pEntry = pSvTabListBox->GetHdlEntry(); @@ -287,7 +287,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvBaseLinksDlg, UpdateNowClickHdl) { SvBaseLinkRef xLink = aLnkArr[ n ]; - // suche erstmal im Array nach dem Eintrag + // first look for the entry in the array for( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < pLinkMgr->GetLinks().Count(); ++i ) if( &xLink == *pLinkMgr->GetLinks()[ i ] ) { @@ -298,7 +298,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvBaseLinksDlg, UpdateNowClickHdl) } } - // falls jemand der Meinung ist, seine Links auszutauschen (SD) + // if somebody is of the opinion to swap his links (SD) LinkManager* pNewMgr = pLinkMgr; pLinkMgr = 0; SetManager( pNewMgr ); @@ -307,7 +307,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvBaseLinksDlg, UpdateNowClickHdl) if( 0 == (pE = rListBox.GetEntry( aPosArr[ 0 ] )) || pE->GetUserData() != aLnkArr[ 0 ] ) { - // suche mal den Link + // search the link pE = rListBox.First(); while( pE ) { @@ -412,13 +412,13 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvBaseLinksDlg, BreakLinkClickHdl, PushButton *, pPushButton ) { Links().GetModel()->Remove( Links().GetEntry( nPos ) ); - // falls Object noch vorhanden, dann das schliessen + // close object, if it's still existing sal_Bool bNewLnkMgr = OBJECT_CLIENT_FILE == xLink->GetObjType(); - // dem Link sagen, das er aufgeloest wird! + // tell the link that it will be resolved! xLink->Closed(); - // falls einer vergessen hat sich auszutragen + // if somebody has forgotten to deregister himself if( xLink.Is() ) pLinkMgr->Remove( &xLink ); @@ -455,21 +455,20 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvBaseLinksDlg, BreakLinkClickHdl, PushButton *, pPushButton ) for( sal_uLong i = 0; i < aLinkList.Count(); i++ ) { SvBaseLinkRef xLink = aLinkList.GetObject( i ); - // dem Link sagen, das er aufgeloest wird! + // tell the link that it will be resolved! xLink->Closed(); - // falls einer vergessen hat sich auszutragen + // if somebody has forgotten to deregister himself pLinkMgr->Remove( &xLink ); bModified = sal_True; } - //Danach alle selektierten Eintraege entfernen + // then remove all selected entries } } if(bModified) { if( !Links().GetEntryCount() ) { - // Der letzte macht das Licht aus Automatic().Disable(); Manual().Disable(); UpdateNow().Disable(); @@ -514,10 +513,10 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvBaseLinksDlg, EndEditHdl, sfx2::SvBaseLink*, _pLink ) if( _pLink && _pLink->WasLastEditOK() ) { - // StarImpress/Draw tauschen die LinkObjecte selbst aus! - // also suche den Link im Manager, wenn der nicht mehr existiert, - // dann setze fuelle die Liste komplett neu. Ansonsten braucht - // nur der editierte Linkt aktualisiert werden. + // StarImpress/Draw swap the LinkObjects themselves! + // So search for the link in the manager; if it does not exist + // anymore, fill the list completely new. Otherwise only the + // edited link needs to be refreshed. sal_Bool bLinkFnd = sal_False; for( sal_uInt16 n = pLinkMgr->GetLinks().Count(); n; ) if( _pLink == &(*pLinkMgr->GetLinks()[ --n ]) ) @@ -572,7 +571,7 @@ void SvBaseLinksDlg::SetManager( LinkManager* pNewMgr ) return; if( pNewMgr ) - // Update muss vor Clear gestoppt werden + // update has to be stopped before clear Links().SetUpdateMode( sal_False ); Links().Clear(); @@ -613,8 +612,8 @@ void SvBaseLinksDlg::InsertEntry( const SvBaseLink& rLink, sal_uInt16 nPos, sal_ pLinkMgr->GetDisplayNames( (SvBaseLink*)&rLink, &sTypeNm, &sFileNm, &sLinkNm, &sFilter ); - // GetTab(0) gibt die Position der von der TabListBox automatisch eingefuegten - // Bitmap. Die Breite der ersten Textspalte ergibt sich deshalb aus Tab(2)-Tab(1) + // GetTab(0) gives the position of the bitmap which is automatically inserted by the TabListBox. + // So the first text column's width is Tab(2)-Tab(1). long nWidthPixel = Links().GetLogicTab( 2 ) - Links().GetLogicTab( 1 ); nWidthPixel -= SV_TAB_BORDER; XubString aTxt = Links().GetEllipsisString( sFileNm, nWidthPixel, TEXT_DRAW_PATHELLIPSIS ); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/pastedlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/pastedlg.cxx index 105178240e19..83d3698e3939 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/pastedlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/pastedlg.cxx @@ -134,7 +134,7 @@ sal_uLong SvPasteObjectDialog::GetFormat( const TransferableDataHelper& rHelper, if ( !pFormats ) pFormats = &rHelper.GetDataFlavorExVector(); - //Dialogbox erzeugen und fuellen + // create and fill dialog box String aSourceName, aTypeName; sal_uLong nSelFormat = 0; SvGlobalName aEmptyNm; diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/plfilter.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/plfilter.cxx index 3987544b7ce7..678db753ad3b 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/plfilter.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/plfilter.cxx @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ void fillNetscapePluginFilters( Sequence< rtl::OUString >& rPluginNames, Sequenc { FilterMap aMap; - // mimetypes zusammenfassen: eine description, mehrere extensions + // sum up the mimetypes: one description, multiple extensions Sequence aDescriptions( xPMgr->getPluginDescriptions() ); const PluginDescription * pDescriptions = aDescriptions.getConstArray(); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/postdlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/postdlg.cxx index 329d8765325a..28ad7ee9100a 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/postdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/postdlg.cxx @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ SvxPostItDialog::SvxPostItDialog( Window* pParent, pOutSet ( 0 ) { - if (bRedline) // HelpIDs fuer Redlining + if (bRedline) // HelpIDs for redlining { SetHelpId(HID_REDLINING_DLG); aEditED.SetHelpId(HID_REDLINING_EDIT); @@ -154,7 +154,7 @@ SvxPostItDialog::SvxPostItDialog( Window* pParent, if ( !bNew ) SetText( CUI_RESSTR( STR_NOTIZ_EDIT ) ); else - // neu anlegen + // create newly SetText( CUI_RESSTR( STR_NOTIZ_INSERT ) ); FreeResource(); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/scriptdlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/scriptdlg.cxx index 30be39a6782e..616ee0ff2dae 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/scriptdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/scriptdlg.cxx @@ -97,7 +97,7 @@ SFTreeListBox::SFTreeListBox( Window* pParent, const ResId& rResId ) : WB_HASLINES | WB_HASLINESATROOT ); SetNodeDefaultImages(); - nMode = 0xFF; // Alles + nMode = 0xFF; // everything } SFTreeListBox::~SFTreeListBox() diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/thesdlg.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/thesdlg.cxx index 64ea8a7fac58..17db9233e6ef 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/thesdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/thesdlg.cxx @@ -667,7 +667,7 @@ SvxThesaurusDialog::~SvxThesaurusDialog() void SvxThesaurusDialog::SetWindowTitle( LanguageType nLanguage ) { - // Sprache anpassen + // adjust language String aStr( GetText() ); aStr.Erase( aStr.Search( sal_Unicode( '(' ) ) - 1 ); aStr.Append( UniString::CreateFromAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( " (" ) ) ); diff --git a/cui/source/dialogs/zoom.cxx b/cui/source/dialogs/zoom.cxx index 2fd600c84f9b..51d9d1779946 100644 --- a/cui/source/dialogs/zoom.cxx +++ b/cui/source/dialogs/zoom.cxx @@ -111,15 +111,15 @@ void SvxZoomDialog::HideButton( sal_uInt16 nBtnId ) { switch ( nBtnId ) { - case ZOOMBTN_OPTIMAL: // Optimal-Button + case ZOOMBTN_OPTIMAL: aOptimalBtn.Hide(); break; - case ZOOMBTN_PAGEWIDTH: // Seitenbreite-Button + case ZOOMBTN_PAGEWIDTH: aPageWidthBtn.Hide(); break; - case ZOOMBTN_WHOLEPAGE: // Ganze Seite-Button + case ZOOMBTN_WHOLEPAGE: aWholePageBtn.Hide(); break; @@ -191,12 +191,12 @@ SvxZoomDialog::SvxZoomDialog( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) : aOKBtn.SetClickHdl( LINK( this, SvxZoomDialog, OKHdl ) ); aUserEdit.SetModifyHdl( LINK( this, SvxZoomDialog, SpinHdl ) ); - // Default-Werte + // default values sal_uInt16 nValue = 100; sal_uInt16 nMin = 10; sal_uInt16 nMax = 1000; - // ggf. erst den alten Wert besorgen + // maybe get the old value first const SfxUInt16Item* pOldUserItem = 0; SfxObjectShell* pSh = SfxObjectShell::Current(); @@ -206,7 +206,7 @@ SvxZoomDialog::SvxZoomDialog( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) : if ( pOldUserItem ) nValue = pOldUserItem->GetValue(); - // UserEdit initialisieren + // initialize UserEdit if ( nMin > nValue ) nMin = nValue; if ( nMax < nValue ) @@ -469,7 +469,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxZoomDialog, OKHdl, Button *, pBtn ) if ( aViewLayoutFl.IsEnabled() ) pOutSet->Put( aViewLayoutItem ); - // Wert aus dem UserEdit "uber den Dialog hinaus merken + // memorize value from the UserEdit beyond the dialog SfxObjectShell* pSh = SfxObjectShell::Current(); if ( pSh ) diff --git a/cui/source/inc/autocdlg.hxx b/cui/source/inc/autocdlg.hxx index 5771fa9469c0..ee2798a74012 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/autocdlg.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/autocdlg.hxx @@ -220,7 +220,7 @@ struct DoubleString { String sShort; String sLong; - void* pUserData; // CheckBox -> form. Text Bool -> Selektionstext + void* pUserData; // CheckBox -> form. Text Bool -> selection text }; typedef std::vector DoubleStringArray; typedef std::map DoubleStringTable; @@ -260,7 +260,7 @@ private: DECL_LINK(NewDelHdl, PushButton*); DECL_LINK(ModifyHdl, Edit*); - void RefillReplaceBox(sal_Bool bFromReset, //Box mit neuer Sprache fuellen + void RefillReplaceBox(sal_Bool bFromReset, LanguageType eOldLanguage, LanguageType eNewLanguage); diff --git a/cui/source/inc/backgrnd.hxx b/cui/source/inc/backgrnd.hxx index 148248a6b040..ce3b0cb41ef9 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/backgrnd.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/backgrnd.hxx @@ -39,9 +39,9 @@ // class SvxBackgroundTabPage -------------------------------------------- /* {k:\svx\prototyp\dialog\backgrnd.bmp} - [Beschreibung] - Mit dieser TabPage kann eine Brush (z.B. fuer die Hintergrundfarbe eines - Rahmens) eingestellt werden. + [Description] + With this TabPage a Brush (e. g. for a frame's background color) + can be set. [Items] : ; */ diff --git a/cui/source/inc/bbdlg.hxx b/cui/source/inc/bbdlg.hxx index 16274938ecaf..7497855c9858 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/bbdlg.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/bbdlg.hxx @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ #include /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Border Background Pages buendeln + Description: bunch the border background pages --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ class SvxBorderBackgroundDlg: public SfxTabDialog diff --git a/cui/source/inc/connect.hxx b/cui/source/inc/connect.hxx index 00898a57c1f6..57cdcc3c73a6 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/connect.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/connect.hxx @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ class SdrView; /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum Aendern von Konnektoren (Connectors) +|* Dialog for changing connectors. |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -101,8 +101,8 @@ public: /************************************************************************* |* -|* Von SfxSingleTabDialog abgeleitet, um vom Control "uber virtuelle Methode -|* benachrichtigt werden zu k"onnen. +|* Derived from SfxSingleTabDialog, in order to be informed about +|* virtual methods by the control. |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/inc/cuifmsearch.hxx b/cui/source/inc/cuifmsearch.hxx index 04c9d1380c5e..3ca5e2965617 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/cuifmsearch.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/cuifmsearch.hxx @@ -103,10 +103,9 @@ class FmSearchDialog : public ModalDialog Link m_lnkContextSupplier; // for search in contexts - // an Array, in dem ich mir fuer jeden Kontext das aktuell selektierte Feld merke + // memorize the currently selected field for every context ::std::vector m_arrContextFields; - // fuer die eigentliche Arbeit ... FmSearchEngine* m_pSearchEngine; Timer m_aDelayedPaint; @@ -114,38 +113,38 @@ class FmSearchDialog : public ModalDialog ::svxform::FmSearchConfigItem* m_pConfig; public: - /** hiermit kann in verschiedenen Saetzen von Feldern gesucht werden. Es gibt eine Reihe von Kontexten, deren Namen in - strContexts stehen (getrennt durch ';'), der Benutzer kann einen davon auswaehlen. - Wenn der Benutzer einen Kontext auswaehlt, wird lnkContextSupplier aufgerufen, er bekommt einen Zeiger auf eine - FmSearchContext-Struktur, die gefuellt werden muss. - Fuer die Suche gilt dann : - a) bei formatierter Suche wird der Iterator selber verwendet (wie beim ersten Constructor auch) - b) bei formatierter Suche wird NICHT der FormatKey an den Fields des Iterators verwendet, sondern die entsprechende - TextComponent wird gefragt (deshalb auch die Verwendung des originalen Iterator, durch dessen Move werden hoffentlich - die hinter den TextComponent-Interfaces stehenden Controls geupdatet) - c) bei nicht formatierter Suche wird ein Clone des Iterators verwendet (da ich hier die TextComponent-Interfaces nicht - fragen muss) - (natuerlich zwingend erforderlich : der String Nummer i in strUsedFields eines Kontexts muss mit dem Interface Nummer i - in arrFields des Kontexts korrespondieren) + /** This can search in different sets of fields. There is a number of contexts; their names are in strContexts (seperated + by ';'), the user can choose one of them. + When the user chooses a context, lnkContextSupplier is called, it gets a pointer on an FmSearchContext-structure, + that has to be filled. + The following counts for the search : + a) in case of formatted search the iterator itself is used (like in the first constructor) + b) in case of formatted search NOT the FormatKey at the fields of the iterator is used, but the respective TextComponent + is asked (that's why the original iterator is used; by its move the controls behind the TextComponent-interface are + updated hopefully) + c) in case of not-formatted search a clone of the iterator is used (because the TextComponent-interfaces don't need to + be asked) + (of course needed : the string number i in strUsedFields of a context must correspond with the interface number i in the + arrFields of the context) */ FmSearchDialog(Window* pParent, const String& strInitialText, const ::std::vector< String >& _rContexts, sal_Int16 nInitialContext, const Link& lnkContextSupplier); virtual ~FmSearchDialog(); - /** der Found-Handler bekommt im "gefunden"-Fall einen Zeiger auf eine FmFoundRecordInformation-Struktur - (dieser ist nur im Handler gueltig, wenn man sich also die Daten merken muss, nicht den Zeiger, sondern die - Struktur kopieren) - Dieser Handler MUSS gesetzt werden. - Ausserdem sollte beachtet werden, dass waehrend des Handlers der Suchdialog immer noch modal ist + /** The found-handler gets in the 'found'-case a pointer on a FmFoundRecordInformation-structure + (which is only valid in the handler; so if one needs to memorize the data, don't copy the pointer but + the structure). + This handler MUST be set. + Furthermore, it should be considered, that during the handler the search-dialog is still modal. */ void SetFoundHandler(const Link& lnk) { m_lnkFoundHandler = lnk; } /** - Wenn die Suche abgebrochen oder erfolglos beendet wurde, wird im Suchdialog immer der aktuelle Datensatz angezeigt - Damit das mit der eventuellen Anzeige des Aufrufers synchron geht, existiert dieser Handler (der nicht undbedingt gesetzt - werden muss). - Der dem Handler uebergebene Zeiger zeigt auf eine FmFoundRecordInformation-Struktur, bei der aPosition und eventuell - (bei Suche mit Kontexten) nContext gueltig sind. + If the search has been cancelled or has been finished without success, the current data set is always displayed in the + search dialog. This handler exists to make this synchronous with the possible display of the caller (it does not + necessarily need to be set). + The pointer that is passed to the handler points to a FmFoundRecordInformation-structure, for which aPosition and + possibly (in a search with contexts) nContext are valid. */ void SetCanceledNotFoundHdl(const Link& lnk) { m_lnkCanceledNotFoundHdl = lnk; } @@ -155,21 +154,22 @@ protected: virtual sal_Bool Close(); void Init(const String& strVisibleFields, const String& strInitialText); - // nur von den Constructoren aus zu verwenden + // only to be used out of the constructors void OnFound(const ::com::sun::star::uno::Any& aCursorPos, sal_Int16 nFieldPos); void EnableSearchUI(sal_Bool bEnable); - // beim Suchen in einem eigenen Thread moechte ich natuerlich die UI zum Starten/Parameter-Setzen der Suche disablen - // Bei bEnable == sal_False wird fuer alle betroffenen Controls das Painten kurz aus- und mittels m_aDelayedPaint nach - // einer kurzen Weile wieder angeschaltet. Wenn inzwischen eine Anforderung mit bEnable==sal_True kommt, wird der Timer gestoppt - // und das Painten gleich wieder angeschaltet. Als Konsequenz dieses umstaendlichen Vorgehens ist kein Flackern zu sehen, - // wenn man schnell hintereinander aus- und wieder einschaltet. + + /* When searching in an own thread I naturally want to disable the UI for starting the search and for setting search + parameters. If bEnalbe == sal_False, for all affected controls painting is turned off and shortly after turned on + again using m_aDelayedPaint. If there is a demand with bEnable == sal_True inbetween, the timer is stopped and + painting is turned on immediately. As a consequence for this intricateness there is no flickering when turning + off and on quickly. + */ void EnableSearchForDependees(sal_Bool bEnable); void EnableControlPaint(sal_Bool bEnable); - // enabled (disabled) fuer alle wichtigen Controls ihr Paint void InitContext(sal_Int16 nContext); @@ -191,7 +191,6 @@ private: DECL_LINK( OnContextSelection, ListBox* ); - // Such-Fortschritt DECL_LINK( OnSearchProgress, FmSearchProgress* ); DECL_LINK( OnDelayedPaint, void* ); diff --git a/cui/source/inc/cuitabarea.hxx b/cui/source/inc/cuitabarea.hxx index a3c22145ac92..b7f5fa68362b 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/cuitabarea.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/cuitabarea.hxx @@ -746,18 +746,18 @@ private: void FillValueSet_Impl( ValueSet& rVs ); //----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- - DECL_LINK( ClickAddHdl_Impl, void * ); // Button 'Hinzufuegen' - DECL_LINK( ClickModifyHdl_Impl, void * ); // Button 'Aendern' - DECL_LINK( ClickDeleteHdl_Impl, void * ); // Button 'loeschen' - DECL_LINK( ClickWorkOnHdl_Impl, void * ); // Button 'Bearbeiten' - - DECL_LINK( SelectColorLBHdl_Impl, void * ); // Farbe aus Listbox ausw�hlen - DECL_LINK( SelectValSetHdl_Impl, void * ); // Farbe aus Farbpalette (links) ausw�hlen - DECL_LINK( SelectColorModelHdl_Impl, void * ); // Auswahl Listbox 'Farbmodell' + DECL_LINK( ClickAddHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( ClickModifyHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( ClickDeleteHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( ClickWorkOnHdl_Impl, void * ); + + DECL_LINK( SelectColorLBHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( SelectValSetHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( SelectColorModelHdl_Impl, void * ); long ChangeColorHdl_Impl( void* p ); - DECL_LINK( ModifiedHdl_Impl, void * ); // Inhalt der Farbwerte-Felder wurde ver�ndert - DECL_LINK( ClickLoadHdl_Impl, void * ); // Button 'Farbtabelle laden' - DECL_LINK( ClickSaveHdl_Impl, void * ); // Button 'Farbtabelle sichern' + DECL_LINK( ModifiedHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( ClickLoadHdl_Impl, void * ); + DECL_LINK( ClickSaveHdl_Impl, void * ); long CheckChanges_Impl(); #endif diff --git a/cui/source/inc/cuitabline.hxx b/cui/source/inc/cuitabline.hxx index 6a0881c3055c..7fb7e04ba75d 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/cuitabline.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/cuitabline.hxx @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ private: FixedText maFTEdgeStyle; LineEndLB maLBEdgeStyle; - //#58425# Symbole auf einer Linie (z.B. StarChart) -> + //#58425# symbols on a line (e. g. StarChart) -> SdrObjList* pSymbolList; //a list of symbols to be shown in menu. Symbol at position SID_ATTR_SYMBOLTYPE is to be shown in preview. The list position is to be used cyclic. bool bNewSize; Graphic aAutoSymbolGraphic; //a graphic to be displayed in the preview in case that an automatic symbol is choosen @@ -177,7 +177,7 @@ private: // #63083# sal_Int32 nActLineWidth; - //Handler f�r Gallery-Popup-Menue-Button + Size + // handler for gallery popup menu button + size DECL_LINK( GraphicHdl_Impl, MenuButton * ); DECL_LINK( MenuCreateHdl_Impl, MenuButton * ); DECL_STATIC_LINK( SvxLineTabPage, GraphicArrivedHdl_Impl, SvxBrushItem* ); diff --git a/cui/source/inc/gallery.hrc b/cui/source/inc/gallery.hrc index d813fa7c7f56..8188e3054918 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/gallery.hrc +++ b/cui/source/inc/gallery.hrc @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ ************************************************************************/ #include -// Gallery-TabDialoge/-TabPages +// Gallery TabDialogs/TabPages #define RID_SVXTABDLG_GALLERY (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START ) #define RID_SVXTABDLG_GALLERYTHEME (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 2) #define RID_SVXDLG_GALLERY_TITLE (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 82) @@ -34,7 +34,7 @@ #define RID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERY_GENERAL (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 1) #define RID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 4) -// Dialoge +// Dialogs #define RID_SVXDLG_GALLERY_SEARCH_PROGRESS (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 6) #define RID_SVXDLG_GALLERY_TAKE_PROGRESS (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 7) #define RID_SVXDLG_GALLERY_ACTUALIZE_PROGRESS (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 8) @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ #define RID_SVXBMP_THEME_READONLY_BIG (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 53) #define RID_SVXBMP_THEME_DEFAULT_BIG (RID_CUI_GALLERY_START + 55) -// lokale Defines +// local Defines #define BTN_OK 1 #define BTN_CANCEL 1 #define BTN_HELP 1 diff --git a/cui/source/inc/iconcdlg.hxx b/cui/source/inc/iconcdlg.hxx index 496e375092cf..41bdf61884ad 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/iconcdlg.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/iconcdlg.hxx @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ class IconChoicePage; // Create-Function typedef IconChoicePage* (*CreatePage)(Window *pParent, const SfxItemSet &rAttrSet); -typedef sal_uInt16* (*GetPageRanges)(); // liefert internationale Which-Wert +typedef sal_uInt16* (*GetPageRanges)(); // gives international Which-value // position of iconchoicectrl enum EIconChoicePos { PosLeft, PosRight, PosTop, PosBottom }; @@ -64,14 +64,14 @@ enum EIconChoicePos { PosLeft, PosRight, PosTop, PosBottom }; struct IconChoicePageData { - sal_uInt16 nId; // Die ID - CreatePage fnCreatePage; // Pointer auf die Factory - GetPageRanges fnGetRanges;// Pointer auf die Ranges-Funktion - IconChoicePage* pPage; // die TabPage selber - sal_Bool bOnDemand; // Flag: ItemSet onDemand - sal_Bool bRefresh; // Flag: Seite mu\s neu initialisiert werden - - // Konstruktor + sal_uInt16 nId; + CreatePage fnCreatePage; // pointer to the factory + GetPageRanges fnGetRanges; // pointer to the ranges-function + IconChoicePage* pPage; // the TabPage itself + sal_Bool bOnDemand; // Flag: ItemSet onDemand + sal_Bool bRefresh; // Flag: page has to be newly initialized + + // constructor IconChoicePageData( sal_uInt16 Id, CreatePage fnPage, GetPageRanges fnRanges, sal_Bool bDemand ) : nId ( Id ), fnCreatePage ( fnPage ), @@ -125,12 +125,11 @@ public : void SetExchangeSupport( sal_Bool bNew = sal_True ) { bHasExchangeSupport = bNew; } enum { - KEEP_PAGE = 0x0000, // Fehlerbehandlung; Seite nicht wechseln - // 2. F"ullen eines ItemSets f"ur die Aktualilsierung - // "ubergeordneter Beispiele; dieser Pointer kann immer - // NULL sein!! + KEEP_PAGE = 0x0000, // error handling + // 2nd filling of an ItemSet for updating superior examples; + // this pointer can always be NULL!! LEAVE_PAGE = 0x0001, - // Set aktualisieren und andere Page aktualisieren + // refresh set and update other pages REFRESH_SET = 0x0002 }; @@ -157,12 +156,12 @@ class IconChoiceDialog : public ModalDialog private : friend class IconChoicePage; - EIconChoicePos meChoicePos; // Position des IconChoiceCtrl's - ::std::vector< IconChoicePageData* > maPageList; // Liste von PageData-Pointer + EIconChoicePos meChoicePos; + ::std::vector< IconChoicePageData* > maPageList; - SvtIconChoiceCtrl maIconCtrl; // DAS IconChoice-Control + SvtIconChoiceCtrl maIconCtrl; - sal_uInt16 mnCurrentPageId; // Id der aktuell sichtbaren Page + sal_uInt16 mnCurrentPageId; // Buttons OKButton aOKBtn; @@ -216,20 +215,20 @@ protected : public : - // im Ctor k�nnte auch die Position des IconChoiceCtrl's gesetzt werden. + // the IconChoiceCtrl's could also be set in the Ctor IconChoiceDialog ( Window* pParent, const ResId &rResId, const EIconChoicePos ePos = PosLeft, const SfxItemSet * pItemSet = 0 ); ~IconChoiceDialog (); /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// - // virtuelle Methoden + // virtual methods // virtual void Paint( const Rectangle& rRect ); virtual void Resize(); /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// - // Schnittstelle + // interface // SvxIconChoiceCtrlEntry* AddTabPage( @@ -241,7 +240,7 @@ public : sal_uInt16 GetCurPageId() const { return mnCurrentPageId; } void ShowPage( sal_uInt16 nId ); - // liefert ggf. per Map konvertierte lokale Slots + // gives via map converted local slots if applicable const sal_uInt16* GetInputRanges( const SfxItemPool& ); void SetInputSet( const SfxItemSet* pInSet ); const SfxItemSet* GetOutputItemSet() const { return pOutSet; } diff --git a/cui/source/inc/macroass.hxx b/cui/source/inc/macroass.hxx index bca7bf490cd0..238638d976a0 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/macroass.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/macroass.hxx @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ public: virtual void ScriptChanged(); virtual void PageCreated (SfxAllItemSet aSet); - // --------- Erben aus der Basis ------------- + // --------- inherit from the base ------------- virtual sal_Bool FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ); virtual void Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ); @@ -113,7 +113,7 @@ public: const SfxItemSet& rSet ); - // --------- Erben aus der Basis ------------- + // --------- inherit from the base ------------- static SfxTabPage* Create( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rAttrSet ); }; diff --git a/cui/source/inc/macropg.hxx b/cui/source/inc/macropg.hxx index 142b416e298c..cf9443661e3c 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/macropg.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/macropg.hxx @@ -123,7 +123,7 @@ public: // class SvxMacroAssignDlg -------------------------------------------------- -typedef sal_uInt16* (*GetTabPageRanges)(); // liefert internationale Which-Werte +typedef sal_uInt16* (*GetTabPageRanges)(); // gives international Which-values class SvxMacroAssignSingleTabDialog : public SfxModalDialog { diff --git a/cui/source/inc/measure.hxx b/cui/source/inc/measure.hxx index 1d7a561301b7..746f2bae9ccd 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/measure.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/measure.hxx @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ class SdrView; /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum "Andern von TextAttributen +|* Dialog for changing TextAtrributes |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -110,8 +110,8 @@ public: /************************************************************************* |* -|* Von SfxSingleTabDialog abgeleitet, um vom Control "uber virtuelle Methode -|* benachrichtigt werden zu k"onnen. +|* Derived from SfxSingleTabDialog, in order to be able to be +|* informed about virtual methods by the control. |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/inc/numfmt.hxx b/cui/source/inc/numfmt.hxx index a87940f8357c..3a9e0272ca3a 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/numfmt.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/numfmt.hxx @@ -131,7 +131,7 @@ private: sal_uLong nInitFormat; Link fnOkHdl; - sal_Bool bNumItemFlag; //Fuer Handling mit DocShell + sal_Bool bNumItemFlag; // for handling with DocShell sal_Bool bOneAreaFlag; short nFixedCategory; diff --git a/cui/source/inc/numpages.hxx b/cui/source/inc/numpages.hxx index b0e9fa1dd57e..00f0ddd82ab2 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/numpages.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/numpages.hxx @@ -149,9 +149,9 @@ class SvxBulletPickTabPage : public SfxTabPage }; /*-------------------------------------------------- - TabPage fuer vollstaendig Numerierung + TabPage for complete numeration --------------------------------------------------*/ -#define NUMTYPE_MEMBER 4 // Anzahl der Elemente des FormatStrings je Ebene +#define NUMTYPE_MEMBER 4 // number of elements of the FormatString per level #define NUM_VALUSET_COUNT 16 class SvxNumPickTabPage : public SfxTabPage { @@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ class SvxNumPickTabPage : public SfxTabPage String sNumCharFmtName; String sBulletCharFmtName; - SvxNumSettingsArr_Impl aNumSettingsArrays[NUM_VALUSET_COUNT]; // wird mit den fuenf Formaten initialisiert + SvxNumSettingsArr_Impl aNumSettingsArrays[NUM_VALUSET_COUNT]; // is initialized with the five formats SvxNumRule* pActNum; SvxNumRule* pSaveNum; @@ -409,7 +409,7 @@ class SvxNumPositionTabPage : public SfxTabPage sal_Bool bModified : 1; sal_Bool bPreset : 1; - sal_Bool bInInintControl : 1; //Modify-Fehler umgehen, soll ab 391 behoben sein + sal_Bool bInInintControl : 1; // workaround for Modify-error, is said to be correctet from 391 on bool bLabelAlignmentPosAndSpaceModeActive; void InitControls(); diff --git a/cui/source/inc/page.hxx b/cui/source/inc/page.hxx index da59f2910caa..4c78455ae38d 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/page.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/page.hxx @@ -45,8 +45,8 @@ /* {k:\svx\prototyp\dialog\page.bmp} - [Beschreibung] - TabPage zur Einstellung einer Seite (Groesse, Raender, ...) + [Description] + TabPage for page settings (size, margins, ...) [Items] : @@ -176,20 +176,16 @@ class SvxPageDescPage : public SfxTabPage DECL_LINK(CenterHdl_Impl, void *); void UpdateExample_Impl( bool bResetbackground = false ); - // Papiergroesse DECL_LINK( PaperSizeSelect_Impl, ListBox* ); DECL_LINK(PaperSizeModify_Impl, void *); DECL_LINK( FrameDirectionModify_Impl, ListBox* ); - // Hintergrund void ResetBackground_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet ); - // Grenzwerte DECL_LINK(RangeHdl_Impl, void *); void CalcMargin_Impl(); - // Registerhaltigkeit DECL_LINK( RegisterModify, CheckBox * ); // page direction diff --git a/cui/source/inc/paragrph.hxx b/cui/source/inc/paragrph.hxx index 1267298e5b68..4ac63127806d 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/paragrph.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/paragrph.hxx @@ -48,9 +48,9 @@ class SvxParagraphControllerItem; /* {k:\svx\prototyp\dialog\parastd.bmp} - [Beschreibung] - Mit dieser TabPage koennen Standard-Attribute eines Absatzes eingestellt - werden (Einzug, Abstand, Ausrichtung, Zeilenabstand). + [Description] + With this TabPage standard attributes of a paragraph can be set + (indention, distance, alignment, line spacing). [Items] @@ -67,7 +67,7 @@ private: SvxStdParagraphTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rSet ); FixedLine aIndentFrm; - // Einzug + // indention FixedText aLeftLabel; SvxRelativeField aLeftIndent; @@ -80,14 +80,14 @@ private: FixedLine aDistFrm; - // Abstaende + // distance FixedText aTopLabel; SvxRelativeField aTopDist; FixedText aBottomLabel; SvxRelativeField aBottomDist; CheckBox aContextualCB; - // Zeilenabstand + // line spacing FixedLine aLineDistFrm; ListBox aLineDist; FixedText aLineDistAtLabel; @@ -96,7 +96,7 @@ private: String sAbsDist; SvxParaPrevWindow aExampleWin; - //Registerhaltigkeit - nur Writer + // only writer FixedLine aRegisterFL; CheckBox aRegisterCB; @@ -146,7 +146,7 @@ class SvxParaAlignTabPage : public SfxTabPage { using TabPage::DeactivatePage; - // Ausrichtung + // alignment FixedLine aAlignFrm; RadioButton aLeft; RadioButton aRight; @@ -199,9 +199,9 @@ public: /* {k:\svx\prototyp\dialog\paraext.bmp} - [Beschreibung] - Mit dieser TabPage koennen Spezial-Attribute eines Absatzes eingestellt - werden (Silbentrennung, Seitenumbruch, Schusterjungen, Hurenkinder, ...). + [Description] + With this TabPage special attributes of a paragraph can be set + (hyphenation, pagebreak, orphan, widow, ...). [Items] @@ -233,7 +233,7 @@ protected: private: SvxExtParagraphTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rSet ); - // Silbentrennung + // hyphenation FixedLine aExtFL; TriStateBox aHyphenBox; FixedText aBeforeText; @@ -243,7 +243,7 @@ private: FixedText aMaxHyphenLabel; NumericField aMaxHyphenEdit; - // Seitenumbruch + // pagebreak FixedLine aBreaksFL; TriStateBox aPageBreakBox; FixedText aBreakTypeFT; @@ -257,11 +257,11 @@ private: FixedLine aExtendFL; - // Absatzteilung + // paragraph division TriStateBox aKeepTogetherBox; TriStateBox aKeepParaBox; - // Witwen/Waisen + // orphan/widow TriStateBox aOrphanBox; NumericField aOrphanRowNo; FixedText aOrphanRowLabel; diff --git a/cui/source/inc/postdlg.hxx b/cui/source/inc/postdlg.hxx index c98041c7d695..7d66cc936b28 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/postdlg.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/postdlg.hxx @@ -41,10 +41,10 @@ /* {k:\svx\prototyp\dialog\memo.bmp} - [Beschreibung] - In diesem Dialog kann eine Notiz erstellt oder bearbeitet werden. Wenn die - Applikation eine Liste von Notizen haelt, kann mit Hilfe von Links, ueber - diese Liste iteriert werden. + [Description] + In this dialog a note can be created or edited. If the + application holds a list of notes, it can be iterated + over this list with links. [Items] diff --git a/cui/source/inc/tabstpge.hxx b/cui/source/inc/tabstpge.hxx index a002a03e7272..1f054d34c69e 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/tabstpge.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/tabstpge.hxx @@ -47,8 +47,8 @@ class TabWin_Impl; /* {k:\svx\prototyp\dialog\tabstop.bmp} - [Beschreibung] - In dieser TabPage werden Tabulatoren verwaltet. + [Description] + In this TabPage tabulators are managed. [Items] @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ protected: private: SvxTabulatorTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rSet ); - // Tabulatoren und Positionen + // tabulators and positions FixedLine aTabLabel; MetricBox aTabBox; FixedLine aTabLabelVert; @@ -99,19 +99,19 @@ private: Edit aDezChar; FixedLine aFillLabel; - // Fuellzeichen + RadioButton aNoFillChar; RadioButton aFillPoints; RadioButton aFillDashLine ; RadioButton aFillSolidLine; RadioButton aFillSpecial; Edit aFillChar; - // Buttons + PushButton aNewBtn; PushButton aDelAllBtn; PushButton aDelBtn; - // lokale Variablen, interne Funktionen + // local variables, internal functions SvxTabStop aAktTab; SvxTabStopItem aNewTabs; long nDefDist; diff --git a/cui/source/inc/textanim.hxx b/cui/source/inc/textanim.hxx index 92bb1b32d749..0c4f5c45b5e0 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/textanim.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/textanim.hxx @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ class SdrView; /************************************************************************* |* -|* Page zum "Andern von TextAnimationen (Lauftext etc.) +|* Page for changing TextAnimations (running text etc.) |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/inc/textattr.hxx b/cui/source/inc/textattr.hxx index acecce5c3ed5..ced0825811a2 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/textattr.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/textattr.hxx @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ class SdrView; /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum "Andern von TextAttributen +|* Dialog for changing TextAttributes |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/inc/transfrm.hxx b/cui/source/inc/transfrm.hxx index ffb98ba25062..2cfd74f81173 100644 --- a/cui/source/inc/transfrm.hxx +++ b/cui/source/inc/transfrm.hxx @@ -189,7 +189,7 @@ public: /************************************************************************* |* -|* Drehwinkel-Tab-Page +|* rotation angle tab page |* \************************************************************************/ class SvxAngleTabPage : public SvxTabPage @@ -246,7 +246,7 @@ public: /************************************************************************* |* -|* Schraegstellen/Eckenradius-Tab-Page +|* slant/corner radius tab page |* \************************************************************************/ class SvxSlantTabPage : public SvxTabPage diff --git a/cui/source/options/dbregister.cxx b/cui/source/options/dbregister.cxx index a17d4f88f4e2..97030c1802da 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/dbregister.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/dbregister.cxx @@ -248,10 +248,10 @@ void DbRegistrationOptionsPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) String aUserData = GetUserData(); if ( aUserData.Len() ) { - // Spaltenbreite restaurieren + // restore column width pHeaderBar->SetItemSize( ITEMID_TYPE, aUserData.GetToken(0).ToInt32() ); HeaderEndDrag_Impl( NULL ); - // Sortierrichtung restaurieren + // restore sort direction sal_Bool bUp = (sal_Bool)(sal_uInt16)aUserData.GetToken(1).ToInt32(); HeaderBarItemBits nBits = pHeaderBar->GetItemBits(ITEMID_TYPE); diff --git a/cui/source/options/fontsubs.cxx b/cui/source/options/fontsubs.cxx index 44e7cef4bfcc..06462872f338 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/fontsubs.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/fontsubs.cxx @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ /*********************************************************************/ /* */ -/* TabPage Fontersetzung */ +/* TabPage font replacement */ /* */ /*********************************************************************/ @@ -312,8 +312,8 @@ IMPL_LINK(SvxFontSubstTabPage, SelectHdl, Window*, pWin) if (pWin == &aNewDelTBX) { SvLBoxEntry* pEntry; - // nCol ist behaemmerterweise die nCol'te Textspalte, werden nicht gezaehlt! - // Daher als Spalte "0". + // nCol is stupidly the nCol'th text column, not counted! + // Therefor "0" as column. sal_uLong nPos = aCheckLB.GetEntryPos(aFont1CB.GetText(), 0); switch (aNewDelTBX.GetCurItemId()) @@ -322,13 +322,13 @@ IMPL_LINK(SvxFontSubstTabPage, SelectHdl, Window*, pWin) { if (nPos != 0xffffffff) { - // Eintrag aendern + // change entry aCheckLB.SetEntryText(aFont2CB.GetText(), nPos, 1); pEntry = aCheckLB.GetEntry(nPos); } else { - // Neuer Eintrag + // new entry String sFont1 = aFont1CB.GetText(); String sFont2 = aFont2CB.GetText(); @@ -422,7 +422,7 @@ void SvxFontSubstTabPage::CheckEnable() sEntry += '\t'; sEntry += aFont2CB.GetText(); - // Wegen OS/2-Optimierungsfehler (Bug #56267) etwas umstaendlicher: + // because of OS/2 optimization error (Bug #56267) a bit more intricate: if (!aFont1CB.GetText().Len() || !aFont2CB.GetText().Len()) bApply = sal_False; else if(aFont1CB.GetText() == aFont2CB.GetText()) diff --git a/cui/source/options/optHeaderTabListbox.cxx b/cui/source/options/optHeaderTabListbox.cxx index 64a7f49ca096..dc87a4d19efc 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optHeaderTabListbox.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optHeaderTabListbox.cxx @@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ void OptHeaderTabListBox::InitEntry( SvLBoxEntry* pEntry, const XubString& rTxt, for ( sal_uInt16 nCol = 1; nCol < _nTabCount; ++nCol ) { - // alle Spalten mit eigener Klasse initialisieren (Spalte 0 == Bitmap) + // initialize all columns with own class (column 0 == Bitmap) SvLBoxString* pCol = (SvLBoxString*)pEntry->GetItem( nCol ); OptLBoxString_Impl* pStr = new OptLBoxString_Impl( pEntry, 0, pCol->GetText() ); pEntry->ReplaceItem( pStr, nCol ); diff --git a/cui/source/options/optdict.cxx b/cui/source/options/optdict.cxx index d33fa83723a7..30f74ec18dcf 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optdict.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optdict.cxx @@ -108,12 +108,12 @@ SvxNewDictionaryDialog::SvxNewDictionaryDialog( Window* pParent, aHelpBtn ( this, CUI_RES( BTN_NEWDICT_HLP ) ), xSpell( xSpl ) { - // Handler installieren + // install handler aNameEdit.SetModifyHdl( LINK( this, SvxNewDictionaryDialog, ModifyHdl_Impl ) ); aOKBtn.SetClickHdl( LINK( this, SvxNewDictionaryDialog, OKHdl_Impl ) ); - // Sprachen anzeigen + // display languages aLanguageLB.SetLanguageList( LANG_LIST_ALL, sal_True, sal_True ); aLanguageLB.SelectEntryPos(0); @@ -150,13 +150,13 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxNewDictionaryDialog, OKHdl_Impl) if ( bFound ) { - // Doppelte Namen? + // duplicate names? InfoBox( this, CUI_RESSTR( RID_SVXSTR_OPT_DOUBLE_DICTS ) ).Execute(); aNameEdit.GrabFocus(); return 0; } - // Erzeugen und hinzufuegen + // create and add sal_uInt16 nLang = aLanguageLB.GetSelectLanguage(); try { @@ -177,7 +177,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxNewDictionaryDialog, OKHdl_Impl) { xNewDic = NULL; - // Fehler: konnte neues W"orterbuch nicht anlegen + // error: couldn't create new dictionary SfxErrorContext aContext( ERRCTX_SVX_LINGU_DICTIONARY, String(), this, RID_SVXERRCTX, &CUI_MGR() ); ErrorHandler::HandleError( *new StringErrorInfo( @@ -262,7 +262,7 @@ SvxEditDictionaryDialog::SvxEditDictionaryDialog( nWidth=aWordED.GetSizePixel().Width(); - // Handler installieren + // install handler aNewReplacePB.SetClickHdl( LINK( this, SvxEditDictionaryDialog, NewDelHdl)); aDeletePB.SetClickHdl( @@ -278,7 +278,7 @@ SvxEditDictionaryDialog::SvxEditDictionaryDialog( aWordED.SetActionHdl(LINK(this, SvxEditDictionaryDialog, NewDelHdl)); aReplaceED.SetActionHdl(LINK(this, SvxEditDictionaryDialog, NewDelHdl)); - // Listbox mit allen verfuegbaren WB's fuellen + // fill listbox with all available WB's const Reference< XDictionary > *pDic = aDics.getConstArray(); sal_Int32 nCount = aDics.getLength(); @@ -433,7 +433,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxEditDictionaryDialog, SelectBookHdl_Impl) { aNewReplacePB.Enable( sal_False ); aDeletePB .Enable( sal_False ); - // Dictionary anzeigen + // display dictionary ShowWords_Impl( nPos ); // enable or disable new and delete button according to file attributes Reference< XDictionary > xDic( aDics.getConstArray()[ nPos ], UNO_QUERY ); @@ -565,8 +565,8 @@ IMPL_LINK(SvxEditDictionaryDialog, SelectHdl, SvTabListBox*, pBox) { SvLBoxEntry* pEntry = pBox->FirstSelected(); String sTmpShort(pBox->GetEntryText(pEntry, 0)); - // wird der Text ueber den ModifyHdl gesetzt, dann steht der Cursor - //sonst immer am Wortanfang, obwohl man gerade hier editiert + // without this the curser is always at the beginning of a word, if the text + // is set over the ModifyHdl, although you're editing there at the moment if(aWordED.GetText() != sTmpShort) aWordED.SetText(sTmpShort); aReplaceED.SetText(pBox->GetEntryText(pEntry, 1)); @@ -666,15 +666,15 @@ IMPL_LINK(SvxEditDictionaryDialog, NewDelHdl, PushButton*, pBtn) aWordsLB.MakeVisible( pNewEntry ); aWordsLB.SetUpdateMode(sal_True); - // falls der Request aus dem ReplaceEdit kam, dann Focus in das ShortEdit setzen + // if the request came from the ReplaceEdit, give focus to the ShortEdit if(aReplaceED.HasFocus()) aWordED.GrabFocus(); } } else { - // das kann nur ein Enter in einem der beiden Edit-Felder sein und das - // bedeutet EndDialog() - muss im KeyInput ausgewertet werden + // this can only be an enter in one of the two edit fields + // which means EndDialog() - has to be evaluated in KeyInput return 0; } ModifyHdl(&aWordED); @@ -793,8 +793,8 @@ void SvxDictEdit::KeyInput( const KeyEvent& rKEvt ) const sal_uInt16 nModifier = aKeyCode.GetModifier(); if( aKeyCode.GetCode() == KEY_RETURN ) { - //wird bei Enter nichts getan, dann doch die Basisklasse rufen - // um den Dialog zu schliessen + // if there's nothing done on enter, call the + // base class after all to close the dialog if(!nModifier && !aActionLink.Call(this)) Edit::KeyInput(rKEvt); } diff --git a/cui/source/options/optfltr.cxx b/cui/source/options/optfltr.cxx index 1e612df6b53f..8a3edd6977f2 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optfltr.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optfltr.cxx @@ -342,7 +342,7 @@ void OfaMSFilterTabPage2::MSFltrSimpleTable::SetTabs() void OfaMSFilterTabPage2::MSFltrSimpleTable::HBarClick() { - // Sortierung durch diese Ueberladung abgeklemmt + // sorting is stopped by this overloading } void OfaMSFilterTabPage2::MSFltrSimpleTable::SetCheckButtonState( diff --git a/cui/source/options/optgenrl.cxx b/cui/source/options/optgenrl.cxx index 9300bede634a..ddf7361015c1 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optgenrl.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optgenrl.cxx @@ -113,7 +113,7 @@ SvxGeneralTabPage::SvxGeneralTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rCoreSe if ( LANGUAGE_ENGLISH_US == eLang ) { - // amerikanische Postadresse aufbauen + // construct American post/mail address aPLZEdit.Hide(); aCityEdit.Hide(); aCityLbl.SetText( CUI_RES( STR_US_STATE ) ); @@ -190,7 +190,7 @@ SvxGeneralTabPage::SvxGeneralTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rCoreSe FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); Link aLink = LINK( this, SvxGeneralTabPage, ModifyHdl_Impl ); @@ -245,7 +245,7 @@ SfxTabPage* SvxGeneralTabPage::Create( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rAttrS sal_Bool SvxGeneralTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) { - // Eingaben trimmen (f"uhrende und nachfolgende Leerzeichen entfernen) + // remove leading and trailing whitespaces aCompanyEdit.SetText( TRIM(aCompanyEdit.GetText()) ); aFirstName.SetText( TRIM(aFirstName.GetText()) ); aName.SetText( TRIM(aName.GetText()) ); diff --git a/cui/source/options/optgenrl.hrc b/cui/source/options/optgenrl.hrc index ed4afd2e803d..ce5d49804154 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optgenrl.hrc +++ b/cui/source/options/optgenrl.hrc @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ #define STR_US_STATE 10 #define STR_QUERY_REG 11 -// Positionierungshilfen f"ur den Dialog +// positioning help for the dialog #define HSPACE 2 #define VSPACE 3 diff --git a/cui/source/options/opthtml.cxx b/cui/source/options/opthtml.cxx index 62dacb07287c..3483e670928b 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/opthtml.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/opthtml.cxx @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ #include #include -// Umwandlung der Modi zu den Positionen in der Listbox +// modus convertion to the positions in the listbox const sal_uInt16 aPosToExportArr[] = { HTML_CFG_MSIE, diff --git a/cui/source/options/optinet2.cxx b/cui/source/options/optinet2.cxx index 81fc6f17a30b..1fee25edae55 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optinet2.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optinet2.cxx @@ -147,7 +147,7 @@ void SvxNoSpaceEdit::Modify() rtl::OUString aValue = GetText(); if ( !comphelper::string::isdigitAsciiString(aValue) || (long)aValue.toInt32() > USHRT_MAX ) - // der H�chstwert einer Portnummer ist USHRT_MAX + // the maximum value of a port number is USHRT_MAX ErrorBox( this, CUI_RES( RID_SVXERR_OPT_PROXYPORTS ) ).Execute(); } } diff --git a/cui/source/options/optlingu.cxx b/cui/source/options/optlingu.cxx index de28f0f913a4..7e2cb756d832 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optlingu.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optlingu.cxx @@ -486,7 +486,7 @@ void BrwString_Impl::Paint( const Point& rPos, SvLBox& rDev, sal_uInt16, Font aFont( aOldFont ); aFont.SetWeight( WEIGHT_BOLD ); - //??? das untere byte aus dem user data in string wandeln + //??? convert the lower byte from the user date into a string OptionsUserData aData( (sal_uLong) pEntry->GetUserData() ); if(aData.HasNumericValue()) { @@ -1206,7 +1206,7 @@ SvxLinguTabPage::~SvxLinguTabPage() //------------------------------------------------------------------------ -//nicht �berladen wegschmeissen +// don't throw away overloaded sal_uInt16* SvxLinguTabPage::GetRanges() { //TL??? @@ -1910,8 +1910,8 @@ SvLBoxEntry* SvxLinguTabPage::CreateEntry( String& rTxt, sal_uInt16 nCol ) if (CBCOL_FIRST == nCol) pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxButton( pEntry, SvLBoxButtonKind_enabledCheckbox, 0, pCheckButtonData ) ); if (CBCOL_SECOND == nCol) - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // Leerspalte - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); // Sonst Puff! + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // empty column + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); pEntry->AddItem( new BrwString_Impl( pEntry, 0, rTxt ) ); return pEntry; @@ -2075,8 +2075,8 @@ SvLBoxEntry* SvxEditModulesDlg::CreateEntry( String& rTxt, sal_uInt16 nCol ) if (CBCOL_FIRST == nCol) pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxButton( pEntry, SvLBoxButtonKind_enabledCheckbox, 0, pCheckButtonData ) ); if (CBCOL_SECOND == nCol) - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // Leerspalte - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); // Sonst Puff! + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // empty column + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); pEntry->AddItem( new BrwStringDic_Impl( pEntry, 0, rTxt ) ); return pEntry; diff --git a/cui/source/options/optmemory.cxx b/cui/source/options/optmemory.cxx index ec1ca167a622..05b3211c2276 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optmemory.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optmemory.cxx @@ -186,7 +186,6 @@ sal_Bool OfaMemoryOptionsPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) boost::shared_ptr< comphelper::ConfigurationChanges > batch( comphelper::ConfigurationChanges::create()); - // Undo-Schritte if ( aUndoEdit.GetText() != aUndoEdit.GetSavedValue() ) officecfg::Office::Common::Undo::Steps::set( aUndoEdit.GetValue(), batch); @@ -236,7 +235,6 @@ void OfaMemoryOptionsPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - // Undo-Schritte aUndoEdit.SetValue(officecfg::Office::Common::Undo::Steps::get()); aUndoEdit.SaveValue(); diff --git a/cui/source/options/optpath.cxx b/cui/source/options/optpath.cxx index ad03c209b649..f1f4d863f868 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optpath.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optpath.cxx @@ -363,10 +363,10 @@ void SvxPathTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) String aUserData = GetUserData(); if ( aUserData.Len() ) { - // Spaltenbreite restaurieren + // restore column width pHeaderBar->SetItemSize( ITEMID_TYPE, aUserData.GetToken(0).ToInt32() ); HeaderEndDrag_Impl( NULL ); - // Sortierrichtung restaurieren + // restore sort direction sal_Bool bUp = (sal_Bool)(sal_uInt16)aUserData.GetToken(1).ToInt32(); HeaderBarItemBits nBits = pHeaderBar->GetItemBits(ITEMID_TYPE); diff --git a/cui/source/options/optsave.cxx b/cui/source/options/optsave.cxx index e2138e7d2f80..6abeaeddbe5a 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/optsave.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/optsave.cxx @@ -328,7 +328,7 @@ sal_Bool SfxSaveTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) (sal_uInt16)aAutoSaveEdit.GetValue() ) ); bModified |= sal_True; } - // relativ speichern + // save relatively if ( aRelativeFsysCB.IsChecked() != aRelativeFsysCB.GetSavedValue() ) { rSet.Put( SfxBoolItem( GetWhich( SID_SAVEREL_FSYS ), @@ -511,7 +511,7 @@ void SfxSaveTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) aAutoSaveEdit.SetValue( aSaveOpt.GetAutoSaveTime() ); - // relativ speichern + // save relatively aRelativeFsysCB.Check( aSaveOpt.IsSaveRelFSys() ); aRelativeInetCB.Check( aSaveOpt.IsSaveRelINet() ); diff --git a/cui/source/options/treeopt.cxx b/cui/source/options/treeopt.cxx index 72a41cef76a8..391f715db60e 100644 --- a/cui/source/options/treeopt.cxx +++ b/cui/source/options/treeopt.cxx @@ -618,7 +618,7 @@ OptionsPageInfo* OfaTreeOptionsDialog::AddTabPage( return pPageInfo; } -// der ItemSet* geht in den Besitz des Dialogs +// the ItemSet* is passed on to the dialog's ownership sal_uInt16 OfaTreeOptionsDialog::AddGroup(const String& rGroupName, SfxShell* pCreateShell, SfxModule* pCreateModule, @@ -681,7 +681,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(OfaTreeOptionsDialog, OKHdl_Impl) int nLeave = pPageInfo->m_pPage->DeactivatePage(pGroupInfo->m_pOutItemSet); if ( nLeave == SfxTabPage::KEEP_PAGE ) { - //die Seite darf nicht verlassen werden! + // the page mustn't be left aTreeLB.Select(pCurrentPageEntry); return 0; } @@ -715,7 +715,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(OfaTreeOptionsDialog, OKHdl_Impl) return 0; } -// Eine aufgeklappte Gruppe soll vollstaendig sichtbar sein +// an opened group shall be completely visible IMPL_LINK(OfaTreeOptionsDialog, ExpandedHdl_Impl, SvTreeListBox*, pBox ) { pBox->Update(); @@ -1031,7 +1031,7 @@ void OfaTreeOptionsDialog::SelectHdl_Impl() } if(bIdentical) pGroupInfo->m_pShell = pGroupInfo->m_pModule; - //jetzt noch testen, ob es auch in anderen Gruppen das gleiche Module gab (z.B. Text+HTML) + // now test whether there was the same module in other groups, too (e. g. Text+HTML) SvLBoxEntry* pTemp = aTreeLB.First(); while(pTemp) { @@ -1281,7 +1281,7 @@ SfxItemSet* OfaTreeOptionsDialog::CreateItemSet( sal_uInt16 nId ) { SfxDispatcher* pDispatch = pViewFrame->GetDispatcher(); - // Sonstiges - Year2000 + // miscellaneous - Year2000 if( SFX_ITEM_AVAILABLE <= pDispatch->QueryState( SID_ATTR_YEAR2000, pItem ) ) pRet->Put( SfxUInt16Item( SID_ATTR_YEAR2000, ((const SfxUInt16Item*)pItem)->GetValue() ) ); else @@ -1291,7 +1291,7 @@ SfxItemSet* OfaTreeOptionsDialog::CreateItemSet( sal_uInt16 nId ) pRet->Put( SfxUInt16Item( SID_ATTR_YEAR2000, (sal_uInt16)aMisc.GetYear2000() ) ); - // Sonstiges - Tabulator + // miscellaneous - Tabulator pRet->Put(SfxBoolItem(SID_PRINTER_NOTFOUND_WARN, aMisc.IsNotFoundWarning())); sal_uInt16 nFlag = aMisc.IsPaperSizeWarning() ? SFX_PRINTER_CHG_SIZE : 0; @@ -1309,7 +1309,7 @@ SfxItemSet* OfaTreeOptionsDialog::CreateItemSet( sal_uInt16 nId ) SID_SET_DOCUMENT_LANGUAGE, SID_SET_DOCUMENT_LANGUAGE, 0 ); - // fuer die Linguistik + // for linguistic Reference< XSpellChecker1 > xSpell = SvxGetSpellChecker(); pRet->Put(SfxSpellCheckItem( xSpell, SID_ATTR_SPELL )); @@ -1415,10 +1415,10 @@ void OfaTreeOptionsDialog::ApplyItemSet( sal_uInt16 nId, const SfxItemSet& rSet aOptSet.Put(rSet); if(aOptSet.Count()) SFX_APP()->SetOptions( aOptSet ); - // Dispatcher neu holen, weil SetOptions() ggf. den Dispatcher zerst"ort hat + // get dispatcher anew, because SetOptions() might have destroyed the dispatcher SfxViewFrame *pViewFrame = SfxViewFrame::Current(); // ------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Year2000 auswerten +// evaluate Year2000 // ------------------------------------------------------------------------- sal_uInt16 nY2K = USHRT_MAX; if( SFX_ITEM_SET == rSet.GetItemState( SID_ATTR_YEAR2000, sal_False, &pItem ) ) @@ -1434,7 +1434,7 @@ void OfaTreeOptionsDialog::ApplyItemSet( sal_uInt16 nId, const SfxItemSet& rSet } // ------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Drucken auswerten +// evaluate print // ------------------------------------------------------------------------- if(SFX_ITEM_SET == rSet.GetItemState(SID_PRINTER_NOTFOUND_WARN, sal_False, &pItem)) aMisc.SetNotFoundWarning(((const SfxBoolItem*)pItem)->GetValue()); @@ -1690,7 +1690,7 @@ void OfaTreeOptionsDialog::Initialize( const Reference< XFrame >& _xFrame ) SvtModuleOptions aModuleOpt; if ( aModuleOpt.IsModuleInstalled( SvtModuleOptions::E_SWRITER ) ) { - // Textdokument + // text document ResStringArray& rTextArray = aDlgResource.GetTextArray(); if ( aFactory.equalsAsciiL( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( "com.sun.star.text.TextDocument" ) ) || aFactory.equalsAsciiL( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( "com.sun.star.text.WebDocument" ) ) @@ -1719,7 +1719,7 @@ void OfaTreeOptionsDialog::Initialize( const Reference< XFrame >& _xFrame ) #endif } - // HTML-Dokument + // HTML documents if ( !lcl_isOptionHidden( SID_SW_ONLINEOPTIONS, aOptionsDlgOpt ) ) { ResStringArray& rHTMLArray = aDlgResource.GetHTMLArray(); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/autocdlg.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/autocdlg.cxx index a2f16f6b0ca6..c459791cffea 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/autocdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/autocdlg.cxx @@ -185,7 +185,7 @@ IMPL_LINK(OfaAutoCorrDlg, SelectLanguageHdl, ListBox*, pBox) sal_uInt16 nPos = pBox->GetSelectEntryPos(); void* pVoid = pBox->GetEntryData(nPos); LanguageType eNewLang = (LanguageType)(long)pVoid; - //alte Einstellungen speichern und neu fuellen + // save old settings and fill anew if(eNewLang != eLastDialogLanguage) { sal_uInt16 nPageId = GetCurPageId(); @@ -288,7 +288,7 @@ void OfaAutocorrOptionsPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) /*********************************************************************/ /* */ -/* Hilfs-struct fuer dUserDaten der Checklistbox */ +/* helping struct for dUserData of the Checklistbox */ /* */ /*********************************************************************/ @@ -304,7 +304,7 @@ struct ImpUserData /*********************************************************************/ /* */ -/* Dialog fuer Prozenteinstellung */ +/* dialog for per cent settings */ /* */ /*********************************************************************/ @@ -331,7 +331,7 @@ class OfaAutoFmtPrcntSet : public ModalDialog /*********************************************************************/ /* */ -/* veraenderter LBoxString */ +/* changed LBoxString */ /* */ /*********************************************************************/ @@ -393,7 +393,7 @@ void OfaImpBrwString::Paint( const Point& rPos, SvLBox& rDev, sal_uInt16 /*nFlag /*********************************************************************/ /* */ -/* TabPage Autoformat anwenden */ +/* use TabPage autoformat */ /* */ /*********************************************************************/ @@ -458,7 +458,7 @@ OfaSwAutoFmtOptionsPage::OfaSwAutoFmtOptionsPage( Window* pParent, { FreeResource(); - //typ. Anfuehrungszeichen einsetzen + // set typ. inverted commas SvtSysLocale aSysLcl; aCheckLB.SetHelpId(HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOFORMAT_CLB); @@ -497,16 +497,16 @@ SvLBoxEntry* OfaSwAutoFmtOptionsPage::CreateEntry(String& rTxt, sal_uInt16 nCol) aCheckLB.SetCheckButtonData( pCheckButtonData ); } - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); // Sonst Puff! + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); String sEmpty; if (nCol == CBCOL_SECOND) - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // Leerspalte + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); else pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxButton( pEntry, SvLBoxButtonKind_enabledCheckbox, 0, pCheckButtonData ) ); if (nCol == CBCOL_FIRST) - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // Leerspalte + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); else pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxButton( pEntry, SvLBoxButtonKind_enabledCheckbox, 0, pCheckButtonData ) ); pEntry->AddItem( new OfaImpBrwString( pEntry, 0, rTxt ) ); @@ -676,8 +676,8 @@ void OfaSwAutoFmtOptionsPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) aCheckLB.SetUpdateMode(sal_False); aCheckLB.Clear(); - // Die folgenden Eintraege muessen in der selben Reihenfolge, wie im - // OfaAutoFmtOptions-enum eingefuegt werden! + // The following entries have to be inserted in the same order + // as in the OfaAutoFmtOptions-enum! aCheckLB.GetModel()->Insert(CreateEntry(sUseReplaceTbl, CBCOL_BOTH )); aCheckLB.GetModel()->Insert(CreateEntry(sCptlSttWord, CBCOL_BOTH )); aCheckLB.GetModel()->Insert(CreateEntry(sCptlSttSent, CBCOL_BOTH )); @@ -784,7 +784,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(OfaSwAutoFmtOptionsPage, EditHdl) } else if( MERGE_SINGLE_LINE_PARA == nSelEntryPos ) { - // Dialog fuer Prozenteinstellung + // dialog for per cent settings OfaAutoFmtPrcntSet aDlg(this); aDlg.GetPrcntFld().SetValue(nPercent); if(RET_OK == aDlg.Execute()) @@ -895,7 +895,7 @@ SvButtonState OfaACorrCheckListBox::GetCheckButtonState( SvLBoxEntry* pEntry, sa void OfaACorrCheckListBox::HBarClick() { - // Sortierung durch diese Ueberladung abgeklemmt + // sorting is stopped by this overload } void OfaACorrCheckListBox::KeyInput( const KeyEvent& rKEvt ) @@ -1007,21 +1007,21 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrReplacePage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) { LanguageType eCurLang = it->first; DoubleStringArray& rDoubleStringArray = it->second; - if(eCurLang != eLang) // die aktuelle Sprache wird weiter hinten behandelt + if(eCurLang != eLang) // the current language is treated later { SvxAutocorrWordList* pWordList = pAutoCorrect->LoadAutocorrWordList(eCurLang); sal_uInt16 nWordListCount = pWordList->Count(); sal_uInt16 nDoubleStringArrayCount = rDoubleStringArray.size(); sal_uInt16 nPos = nDoubleStringArrayCount; sal_uInt16 nLastPos = nPos; - // 1. Durchlauf: Eintraege loeschen oder veraendern: + // 1st run: delete or change entries: for( sal_uInt16 nWordListPos = nWordListCount; nWordListPos; nWordListPos-- ) { SvxAutocorrWordPtr pWordPtr = pWordList->GetObject(nWordListPos - 1); String sEntry(pWordPtr->GetShort()); - // formatierter Text steht nur im Writer + // formatted text is only in Writer sal_Bool bFound = !bSWriter && !pWordPtr->IsTextOnly(); while(!bFound && nPos) { @@ -1052,7 +1052,7 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrReplacePage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) nDoubleStringArrayCount = rDoubleStringArray.size(); for(sal_uInt16 nDoubleStringArrayPos = 0; nDoubleStringArrayPos < nDoubleStringArrayCount; nDoubleStringArrayPos++ ) { - //jetzt sollte es nur noch neue Eintraege geben + // now there should only be new entries left DoubleString& rDouble = rDoubleStringArray[ nDoubleStringArrayPos ]; if(rDouble.pUserData == &bHasSelectionText) pAutoCorrect->PutText( rDouble.sShort, @@ -1066,7 +1066,7 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrReplacePage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) } } aDoubleStringTable.clear(); - // jetzt noch die aktuelle Selektion + // and now the current selection SvxAutocorrWordList* pWordList = pAutoCorrect->LoadAutocorrWordList(eLang); sal_uInt16 nWordListCount = pWordList->Count(); sal_uInt16 nListBoxCount = (sal_uInt16)aReplaceTLB.GetEntryCount(); @@ -1074,14 +1074,14 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrReplacePage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) aReplaceTLB.SetUpdateMode(sal_False); sal_uInt16 nListBoxPos = nListBoxCount; sal_uInt16 nLastListBoxPos = nListBoxPos; - // 1. Durchlauf: Eintraege loeschen oder veraendern: + // 1st run: delete or change entries: sal_uInt16 i; for( i = nWordListCount; i; i-- ) { SvxAutocorrWordPtr pWordPtr = pWordList->GetObject(i- 1); String sEntry(pWordPtr->GetShort()); - // formatierter Text steht nur im Writer + // formatted text is only in Writer sal_Bool bFound = !bSWriter && !pWordPtr->IsTextOnly(); while(!bFound && nListBoxPos) { @@ -1114,7 +1114,7 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrReplacePage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) nListBoxCount = (sal_uInt16)aReplaceTLB.GetEntryCount(); for(i = 0; i < nListBoxCount; i++ ) { - //jetzt sollte es nur noch neue Eintraege geben + // now there should only be new entries left SvLBoxEntry* pEntry = aReplaceTLB.GetEntry( i ); String sShort = aReplaceTLB.GetEntryText(pEntry, 0); if(pEntry->GetUserData() == &bHasSelectionText) @@ -1173,7 +1173,7 @@ void OfaAutocorrReplacePage::RefillReplaceBox(sal_Bool bFromReset, { DoubleString& rDouble = rArray[i]; sal_Bool bTextOnly = 0 == rDouble.pUserData; - // formatierter Text wird nur im Writer angeboten + // formatted text is only in Writer if(bSWriter || bTextOnly) { String sEntry(rDouble.sShort); @@ -1182,7 +1182,7 @@ void OfaAutocorrReplacePage::RefillReplaceBox(sal_Bool bFromReset, SvLBoxEntry* pEntry = aReplaceTLB.InsertEntry(sEntry); aTextOnlyCB.Check(bTextOnly); if(!bTextOnly) - pEntry->SetUserData(rDouble.pUserData); // Das heisst: mit Formatinfo oder sogar mit Selektionstext + pEntry->SetUserData(rDouble.pUserData); // that means: with format info or even with selection text } else aFormatText.insert(rDouble.sShort); @@ -1197,7 +1197,7 @@ void OfaAutocorrReplacePage::RefillReplaceBox(sal_Bool bFromReset, { SvxAutocorrWordPtr pWordPtr = pWordList->GetObject(i); sal_Bool bTextOnly = pWordPtr->IsTextOnly(); - // formatierter Text wird nur im Writer angeboten + // formatted text is only in Writer if(bSWriter || bTextOnly) { String sEntry(pWordPtr->GetShort()); @@ -1206,7 +1206,7 @@ void OfaAutocorrReplacePage::RefillReplaceBox(sal_Bool bFromReset, SvLBoxEntry* pEntry = aReplaceTLB.InsertEntry(sEntry); aTextOnlyCB.Check(pWordPtr->IsTextOnly()); if(!bTextOnly) - pEntry->SetUserData(&aTextOnlyCB); // Das heisst: mit Formatinfo + pEntry->SetUserData(&aTextOnlyCB); // that means: with format info } else aFormatText.insert(pWordPtr->GetShort()); @@ -1259,20 +1259,20 @@ IMPL_LINK(OfaAutocorrReplacePage, SelectHdl, SvTabListBox*, pBox) { SvLBoxEntry* pEntry = pBox->FirstSelected(); String sTmpShort(pBox->GetEntryText(pEntry, 0)); - // wird der Text ueber den ModifyHdl gesetzt, dann steht der Cursor sonst immer am Wortanfang, - // obwohl man gerade hier editiert + // if the text is set via ModifyHdl, the cursor is always at the beginning + // of a word, although you're editing here sal_Bool bSameContent = 0 == pCompareClass->compareString( sTmpShort, aShortED.GetText() ); Selection aSel = aShortED.GetSelection(); if(aShortED.GetText() != sTmpShort) { aShortED.SetText(sTmpShort); - //war es nur eine andere Schreibweise, dann muss die Selektion auch wieder gesetzt werden + // if it was only a different notation, the selection has to be set again if(bSameContent) aShortED.SetSelection(aSel); } aReplaceED.SetText(pBox->GetEntryText(pEntry, 1)); - // mit UserData gibt es eine Formatinfo + // with UserData there is a Formatinfo aTextOnlyCB.Check(0 == pEntry->GetUserData()); } else @@ -1329,11 +1329,11 @@ IMPL_LINK(OfaAutocorrReplacePage, NewDelHdl, PushButton*, pBtn) sEntry, static_cast< SvLBoxEntry * >(NULL), false, nPos == USHRT_MAX ? LIST_APPEND : nPos); if( !bReplaceEditChanged && !aTextOnlyCB.IsChecked()) - pInsEntry->SetUserData(&bHasSelectionText); // neuer formatierter Text + pInsEntry->SetUserData(&bHasSelectionText); // new formatted text aReplaceTLB.MakeVisible( pInsEntry ); aReplaceTLB.SetUpdateMode(sal_True); - // falls der Request aus dem ReplaceEdit kam, dann Focus in das ShortEdit setzen + // if the request came from the ReplaceEdit, give focus to the ShortEdit if(aReplaceED.HasFocus()) aShortED.GrabFocus(); @@ -1341,8 +1341,8 @@ IMPL_LINK(OfaAutocorrReplacePage, NewDelHdl, PushButton*, pBtn) } else { - // das kann nur ein Enter in einem der beiden Edit-Felder sein und das - // bedeutet EndDialog() - muss im KeyInput ausgewertet werden + // this can only be an enter in one of the two edit fields + // which means EndDialog() - has to be evaluated in KeyInput return 0; } ModifyHdl(&aShortED); @@ -1528,7 +1528,7 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrExceptPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) { LanguageType eCurLang = it1->first; StringsArrays& rArrays = it1->second; - if(eCurLang != eLang) // die aktuelle Sprache wird weiter hinten behandelt + if(eCurLang != eLang) // current language is treated later { SvStringsISortDtor* pWrdList = pAutoCorrect->LoadWrdSttExceptList(eCurLang); @@ -1539,7 +1539,7 @@ sal_Bool OfaAutocorrExceptPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& ) for( i = nCount; i; ) { String* pString = pWrdList->GetObject( --i ); - //Eintrag finden u. gfs entfernen + if( !lcl_FindInArray(rArrays.aDoubleCapsStrings, *pString)) pWrdList->DeleteAndDestroy( i ); } @@ -1633,7 +1633,7 @@ void OfaAutocorrExceptPage::SetLanguage(LanguageType eSet) { if(eLang != eSet) { - //alte Einstellungen speichern und neu fuellen + // save old settings and fill anew RefillReplaceBoxes(sal_False, eLang, eSet); eLastDialogLanguage = eSet; delete pCompareClass; @@ -1790,8 +1790,8 @@ void AutoCorrEdit::KeyInput( const KeyEvent& rKEvt ) const sal_uInt16 nModifier = aKeyCode.GetModifier(); if( aKeyCode.GetCode() == KEY_RETURN ) { - //wird bei Enter nichts getan, dann doch die Basisklasse rufen - // um den Dialog zu schliessen + // if there's nothing done on enter, call the + // base class after all to close the dialog if(!nModifier && !aActionLink.Call(this)) Edit::KeyInput(rKEvt); } @@ -1815,16 +1815,16 @@ SvLBoxEntry* OfaQuoteTabPage::CreateEntry(String& rTxt, sal_uInt16 nCol) aSwCheckLB.SetCheckButtonData( pCheckButtonData ); } - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); // Sonst Puff! + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxContextBmp( pEntry, 0, Image(), Image(), 0)); String sEmpty; if (nCol == CBCOL_SECOND) - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // Leerspalte + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); else pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxButton( pEntry, SvLBoxButtonKind_enabledCheckbox, 0, pCheckButtonData ) ); if (nCol == CBCOL_FIRST) - pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); // Leerspalte + pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxString( pEntry, 0, sEmpty) ); else pEntry->AddItem( new SvLBoxButton( pEntry, SvLBoxButtonKind_enabledCheckbox, 0, pCheckButtonData ) ); @@ -2085,7 +2085,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( OfaQuoteTabPage, QuoteHdl, PushButton*, pBtn ) nMode = DBL_START; else if(pBtn == &aEndQuotePB) nMode = DBL_END; - // Zeichenauswahl-Dialog starten + // start character selection dialog SvxCharacterMap* pMap = new SvxCharacterMap( this, sal_True ); pMap->SetCharFont( OutputDevice::GetDefaultFont(DEFAULTFONT_LATIN_TEXT, LANGUAGE_ENGLISH_US, DEFAULTFONT_FLAGS_ONLYONE, 0 )); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/backgrnd.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/backgrnd.cxx index 8adf23a8b833..526ae3001d91 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/backgrnd.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/backgrnd.cxx @@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ #include #include -// Tabellenhintergrund +// table background #define TBL_DEST_CELL 0 #define TBL_DEST_ROW 1 #define TBL_DEST_TBL 2 @@ -149,9 +149,9 @@ sal_uInt16 GetItemId_Impl( ValueSet& rValueSet, const Color& rCol ) // class BackgroundPreview ----------------------------------------------- -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Vorschaufenster f"ur Brush oder Bitmap + preview window for brush or bitmap */ class BackgroundPreviewImpl : public Window @@ -359,7 +359,7 @@ SvxBackgroundTabPage::SvxBackgroundTabPage( Window* pParent, pParaBck_Impl ( NULL ) { - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); const SfxPoolItem* pItem; @@ -413,9 +413,9 @@ SvxBackgroundTabPage::~SvxBackgroundTabPage() sal_uInt16* SvxBackgroundTabPage::GetRanges() -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - gibt den Bereich der Which-Werte zur"uck + returns the area of the which-values */ { @@ -427,9 +427,9 @@ sal_uInt16* SvxBackgroundTabPage::GetRanges() SfxTabPage* SvxBackgroundTabPage::Create( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rAttrSet ) -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Create-Methode f"ur den TabDialog + create method for the TabDialog */ { @@ -440,8 +440,8 @@ SfxTabPage* SvxBackgroundTabPage::Create( Window* pParent, void SvxBackgroundTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { -// os: So ein Unsinn! Irgendwo laesst sich so ein Item immer finden, -// es muss aber im rSet vorhanden sein! +// os: Such a nonsense! One will always find such an item somewhere, +// but it must be existing in the rSet! // const SfxPoolItem* pX = GetOldItem( rSet, SID_VIEW_FLD_PIC ); // if( pX && pX->ISA(SfxWallpaperItem)) if(SFX_ITEM_AVAILABLE <= rSet.GetItemState(GetWhich(SID_VIEW_FLD_PIC), sal_False)) @@ -450,15 +450,15 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) return; } - // Zustand des Vorschau-Buttons durch UserData persistent + // condition of the preview button is persistent due to UserData String aUserData = GetUserData(); aBtnPreview.Check( aUserData.Len() && sal_Unicode('1') == aUserData.GetChar( 0 ) ); - // nach Reset kein ShowSelector() mehr aufrufen d"urfen + // don't be allowed to call ShowSelector() after reset anymore bAllowShowSelector = sal_False; - // Input-BrushItem besorgen und auswerten + // get and evaluate Input-BrushItem const SvxBrushItem* pBgdAttr = NULL; sal_uInt16 nSlot = SID_ATTR_BRUSH; const SfxPoolItem* pItem; @@ -487,11 +487,11 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) SID_PARA_BACKGRND_DESTINATION, sal_False, &pItem ) ) { nDestValue = ((const SfxUInt16Item*)pItem)->GetValue(); - // ist gerade Zeichen aktiviert? + // character activated? sal_uInt16 nParaSel = aParaLBox.GetSelectEntryPos(); if(1 == nParaSel) { - // dann war das ein "Standard" - Aufruf + // then it was a "standard"-call nDestValue = nParaSel; } aParaLBox.SelectEntryPos(nDestValue); @@ -635,11 +635,11 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ResetFromWallpaperItem( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { ShowSelector(); - // Zustand des Vorschau-Buttons durch UserData persistent + // condition of the preview button is persistent due to UserData String aUserData = GetUserData(); aBtnPreview.Check( aUserData.Len() && sal_Unicode('1') == aUserData.GetChar( 0 ) ); - // Input-BrushItem besorgen und auswerten + // get and evaluate Input-BrushItem const SvxBrushItem* pBgdAttr = NULL; sal_uInt16 nSlot = SID_VIEW_FLD_PIC; sal_uInt16 nWhich = GetWhich( nSlot ); @@ -658,7 +658,7 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ResetFromWallpaperItem( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) if ( pBgdAttr ) { FillControls_Impl(*pBgdAttr, aUserData); - // Auch bei Anzeige der Grafik, soll die Brush erhalten bleiben + // brush shall be kept when showing the graphic, too if( aBgdColor != pBgdAttr->GetColor() ) { aBgdColor = pBgdAttr->GetColor(); @@ -693,12 +693,12 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ResetFromWallpaperItem( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) void SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillUserData() -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Beim Destruieren einer SfxTabPage wird diese virtuelle Methode gerufen, - damit die TabPage interne Informationen sichern kann. + When destroying a SfxTabPage this virtual method is called, + so that the TabPage can save internal information. - In diesem Fall wird der Zustand des Vorschau-Buttons gesichert. + In this case the condition of the preview button is saved. */ { @@ -714,8 +714,8 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) pPageImpl->pLoadTimer->Stop(); LoadTimerHdl_Impl( pPageImpl->pLoadTimer ); } -// os: So ein Unsinn! Irgendwo laesst sich so ein Item immer finden, -// es muss aber im rSet vorhanden sein! +// os: Such a nonsense! One will always find such an item somewhere, +// but it must be existing in the rSet! // const SfxPoolItem* pX = GetOldItem( rCoreSet, SID_VIEW_FLD_PIC ); // if( pX && pX->ISA(SfxWallpaperItem)) @@ -772,13 +772,13 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) aBgdColor.SetTransparency(lcl_PercentToTransparency(static_cast(aColTransMF.GetValue()))); } if ( ( (GPOS_NONE == eOldPos) && bIsBrush ) - || ( (GPOS_NONE != eOldPos) && !bIsBrush ) ) // Brush <-> Bitmap gewechselt? + || ( (GPOS_NONE != eOldPos) && !bIsBrush ) ) // Brush <-> Bitmap changed? { - // Hintergrund-Art wurde nicht gewechselt: + // background art hasn't been changed: if ( (GPOS_NONE == eOldPos) || !aLbSelect.IsVisible() ) { - // Brush-Behandlung: + // Brush-treatment: if ( rOldItem.GetColor() != aBgdColor || (SFX_ITEM_AVAILABLE >= eOldItemState && !aBackgroundColorSet.IsNoSelection())) { @@ -790,7 +790,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) } else { - // Bitmap-Behandlung: + // Bitmap-treatment: SvxGraphicPosition eNewPos = GetGraphicPosition_Impl(); const sal_Bool bIsLink = aBtnLink.IsChecked(); @@ -831,7 +831,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) rCoreSet.ClearItem( nWhich ); } } - else // Brush <-> Bitmap gewechselt! + else // Brush <-> Bitmap changed! { if ( bIsBrush ) rCoreSet.Put( SvxBrushItem( aBgdColor, nWhich ) ); @@ -873,7 +873,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) if( aTblLBox.IsVisible() ) { - // Der aktuelle Zustand wurde bereits geputtet + // the current condition has already been put if( nSlot != SID_ATTR_BRUSH && pTableBck_Impl->pCellBrush) { const SfxPoolItem* pOldCell = @@ -919,8 +919,8 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreSet ) } else if(aParaLBox.GetData() == &aParaLBox) { - // Der aktuelle Zustand wurde bereits geputtet - if( nSlot != SID_ATTR_BRUSH && aParaLBox.IsVisible()) // nicht im Suchen-Format-Dialog + // the current condition has already been put + if( nSlot != SID_ATTR_BRUSH && aParaLBox.IsVisible()) // not in search format dialog { const SfxPoolItem* pOldPara = GetOldItem( rCoreSet, SID_ATTR_BRUSH ); @@ -971,13 +971,13 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSetWithWallpaperItem( SfxItemSet& rCoreSe sal_Bool bModified = sal_False; if ( ( (GPOS_NONE == eOldPos) && bIsBrush ) - || ( (GPOS_NONE != eOldPos) && !bIsBrush ) ) // Brush <-> Bitmap gewechselt? + || ( (GPOS_NONE != eOldPos) && !bIsBrush ) ) // Brush <-> Bitmap changed? { - // Hintergrund-Art wurde nicht gewechselt: + // background art hasn't been changed if ( (GPOS_NONE == eOldPos) || !aLbSelect.IsVisible() ) { - // Brush-Behandlung: + // Brush-treatment: if ( rOldItem.GetColor() != aBgdColor ) { bModified = sal_True; @@ -990,7 +990,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSetWithWallpaperItem( SfxItemSet& rCoreSe } else { - // Bitmap-Behandlung: + // Bitmap-treatment: SvxGraphicPosition eNewPos = GetGraphicPosition_Impl(); int bBitmapChanged = ( ( eNewPos != eOldPos ) || @@ -1011,7 +1011,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSetWithWallpaperItem( SfxItemSet& rCoreSe rCoreSet.ClearItem( nWhich ); } } - else // Brush <-> Bitmap gewechselt! + else // Brush <-> Bitmap changed! { CntWallpaperItem aItem( nWhich ); if ( bIsBrush ) @@ -1038,9 +1038,9 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillItemSetWithWallpaperItem( SfxItemSet& rCoreSe int SvxBackgroundTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - virtuelle Methode, wird beim Deaktivieren gerufen + virtual method; is called on deactivation */ { @@ -1057,7 +1057,7 @@ int SvxBackgroundTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) void SvxBackgroundTabPage::PointChanged( Window* , RECT_POINT ) { - // muss implementiert werden, damit Position-Control funktioniert + // has to be implemented so that position control can work } //----------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -1076,9 +1076,9 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ShowSelector() aBtnTile.SetClickHdl( HDL(RadioClickHdl_Impl) ); aBtnPosition.SetClickHdl( HDL(RadioClickHdl_Impl) ); - // Verz"ogertes Laden "uber Timer (wg. UI-Update) + // delayed loading via timer (because of UI-Update) pPageImpl->pLoadTimer = new Timer; - pPageImpl->pLoadTimer->SetTimeout( 500 ); // 500ms verz"ogern + pPageImpl->pLoadTimer->SetTimeout( 500 ); pPageImpl->pLoadTimer->SetTimeoutHdl( LINK( this, SvxBackgroundTabPage, LoadTimerHdl_Impl ) ); @@ -1122,12 +1122,6 @@ sal_Bool SvxBackgroundTabPage::LoadLinkedGraphic_Impl() void SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillColorValueSets_Impl() - -/* [Beschreibung] - - F"ullen des Farb-Sets -*/ - { SfxObjectShell* pDocSh = SfxObjectShell::Current(); const SfxPoolItem* pItem = NULL; @@ -1183,10 +1177,10 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillColorValueSets_Impl() void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ShowColorUI_Impl() -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Die Controls f"ur das Einstellen der Grafik ausblenden und die - Controls f"ur die Farbeinstellung einblenden. + Hide the controls for editing the bitmap + and show the controls for color settings instead. */ { @@ -1221,10 +1215,10 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ShowColorUI_Impl() void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ShowBitmapUI_Impl() -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Die Controls f"ur die Farbeinstellung ausblenden und die - Controls f"ur das Einstellen der Grafik einblenden. + Hide the the controls for color settings + and show controls for editing the bitmap instead. */ { @@ -1263,12 +1257,6 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ShowBitmapUI_Impl() //------------------------------------------------------------------------ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::SetGraphicPosition_Impl( SvxGraphicPosition ePos ) - -/* [Beschreibung] - - Die Controls f"ur die Grafikposition einstellen. -*/ - { switch ( ePos ) { @@ -1315,12 +1303,6 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::SetGraphicPosition_Impl( SvxGraphicPosition ePos ) //------------------------------------------------------------------------ SvxGraphicPosition SvxBackgroundTabPage::GetGraphicPosition_Impl() - -/* [Beschreibung] - - Die Position der Grafik zur"uckgeben. -*/ - { if ( aBtnTile.IsChecked() ) return GPOS_TILED; @@ -1370,12 +1352,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBackgroundTabPage, SelectHdl_Impl) if ( 0 == aLbSelect.GetSelectEntryPos() ) { ShowColorUI_Impl(); - aParaLBox.Enable(); // Zeichenhintergrund kann keine Bitmap sein + aParaLBox.Enable(); // drawing background can't be a bitmap } else { ShowBitmapUI_Impl(); - aParaLBox.Enable(sal_False);// Zeichenhintergrund kann keine Bitmap sein + aParaLBox.Enable(sal_False); // drawing background can't be a bitmap } return 0; } @@ -1413,8 +1395,8 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, FileClickHdl_Impl, CheckBox*, pBox ) } else { - if ( aBgdGraphicPath.Len() > 0 ) // nur bei gelinkter Grafik - RaiseLoadError_Impl(); // ein Fehler + if ( aBgdGraphicPath.Len() > 0 ) // only for linked bitmap + RaiseLoadError_Impl(); pPreviewWin2->NotifyChange( NULL ); } } @@ -1448,10 +1430,10 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, RadioClickHdl_Impl, RadioButton*, pBtn ) IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBackgroundTabPage, BrowseHdl_Impl) -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Handler, gerufen durch das Dr"ucken des Durchsuchen-Buttons. - Grafik/Einf"ugen-Dialog erzeugen, Pfad setzen und starten. + Handler, called by pressing the browse button. + Create graphic/insert dialog, set path and start. */ { @@ -1472,12 +1454,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBackgroundTabPage, BrowseHdl_Impl) { if ( bHtml ) aBtnLink.Check(); - // wenn Verkn"upfen nicht gecheckt ist und die Vorschau auch nicht, - // dann die Vorschau aktivieren, damit der Anwender sieht, - // welche Grafik er ausgew"ahlt hat + // if link isn't checked and preview isn't, either, + // activate preview, so that the user sees which + // graphic he has chosen if ( !aBtnLink.IsChecked() && !aBtnPreview.IsChecked() ) aBtnPreview.Check( sal_True ); - // timer-verz"ogertes Laden der Grafik + // timer-delayed loading of the graphic pPageImpl->pLoadTimer->Start(); } else @@ -1489,11 +1471,11 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBackgroundTabPage, BrowseHdl_Impl) IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, LoadTimerHdl_Impl, Timer* , pTimer ) -/* [Beschreibung] +/* [Description] - Verz"ogertes Laden der Grafik. - Grafik wird nur dann geladen, wenn sie unterschiedlich zur - aktuellen Grafik ist. + Delayed loading of the graphic. + Graphic is only loaded, if it's + different to the current graphic. */ { @@ -1507,7 +1489,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, LoadTimerHdl_Impl, Timer* , pTimer ) INetURLObject aNew( pImportDlg->GetPath() ); if ( !aBgdGraphicPath.Len() || aNew != aOld ) { - // neue Datei gew"ahlt + // new file chosen aBgdGraphicPath = pImportDlg->GetPath(); aBgdGraphicFilter = pImportDlg->GetCurrentFilter(); sal_Bool bLink = ( nHtmlMode & HTMLMODE_ON ) || bLinkOnly ? sal_True : pImportDlg->IsAsLink(); @@ -1528,7 +1510,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, LoadTimerHdl_Impl, Timer* , pTimer ) } } else - bIsGraphicValid = sal_False; // Grafik erst beim Preview-Click laden + bIsGraphicValid = sal_False; // load graphic not until preview click if ( aBtnPreview.IsChecked() && bIsGraphicValid ) { @@ -1567,7 +1549,7 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::ShowParaControl(sal_Bool bCharOnly) aTblDesc.Show(); aParaLBox.Show(); } - aParaLBox.SetData(&aParaLBox); // hier erkennt man, dass dieser Mode eingeschaltet ist + aParaLBox.SetData(&aParaLBox); // here it can be recognized that this mode is turned on } //----------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -1596,7 +1578,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, TblDestinationHdl_Impl, ListBox*, pBox ) pTableBck_Impl->nActPos = nSelPos; if(!*pActItem) *pActItem = new SvxBrushItem(nWhich); - if(0 == aLbSelect.GetSelectEntryPos()) // Brush ausgewaehlt + if(0 == aLbSelect.GetSelectEntryPos()) // brush selected { **pActItem = SvxBrushItem( aBgdColor, nWhich ); } @@ -1666,7 +1648,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxBackgroundTabPage, ParaDestinationHdl_Impl, ListBox*, pBox ) break; } pParaBck_Impl->nActPos = nSelPos; - if(0 == aLbSelect.GetSelectEntryPos()) // Brush ausgewaehlt + if(0 == aLbSelect.GetSelectEntryPos()) // brush selected { sal_uInt16 nWhich = (*pActItem)->Which(); **pActItem = SvxBrushItem( aBgdColor, nWhich ); @@ -1748,7 +1730,7 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillControls_Impl( const SvxBrushItem& rBgdAttr, } pPreviewWin1->NotifyChange( aBgdColor ); - if ( aLbSelect.IsVisible() ) // Grafikteil initialisieren + if ( aLbSelect.IsVisible() ) // initialize graphic part { aBgdGraphicFilter.Erase(); aBgdGraphicPath.Erase(); @@ -1758,7 +1740,7 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillControls_Impl( const SvxBrushItem& rBgdAttr, aBtnLink.Check( sal_False ); aBtnLink.Disable(); pPreviewWin2->NotifyChange( NULL ); - SetGraphicPosition_Impl( GPOS_TILED ); // Kacheln als Default + SetGraphicPosition_Impl( GPOS_TILED ); // tiles as default } } else @@ -1805,8 +1787,8 @@ void SvxBackgroundTabPage::FillControls_Impl( const SvxBrushItem& rBgdAttr, if ( !pStrLink || aBtnPreview.IsChecked() ) { - // Grafik ist im Item vorhanden und muss nicht - // geladen werden: + // Graphic exists in the item and doesn't have + // to be loaded: const Graphic* pGraphic = rBgdAttr.GetGraphic(); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/border.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/border.cxx index fd9c63c74cab..f7c69dad02da 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/border.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/border.cxx @@ -61,17 +61,17 @@ using namespace ::editeng; // ----------------------------------------------------------------------- /* - * [Beschreibung:] - * TabPage zum Einstellen der Rahmen-Attribute. - * Benoetigt - * ein SvxShadowItem: Schatten - * ein SvxBoxItem: Linien links,rechts,oben,unten ), - * ein SvxBoxInfo: Linien vertikal,horizontal, Abstaende, Flags ) + * [Description:] + * TabPage for setting the border attributes. + * Needs + * a SvxShadowItem: shadow + * a SvxBoxItem: lines left, right, top, bottom, + * a SvxBoxInfo: lines vertical, horizontal, distance, flags * - * Linien koennen drei Zustaende haben. - * 1. Show ( -> gueltige Werte ) + * Lines can have three conditions: + * 1. Show ( -> valid values ) * 2. Hide ( -> NULL-Pointer ) - * 3. DontCare ( -> gesonderte Valid-Flags im InfoItem ) + * 3. DontCare ( -> special Valid-Flags in the InfoItem ) */ // static ---------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -149,7 +149,7 @@ SvxBorderTabPage::SvxBorderTabPage( Window* pParent, mbSync(true) { - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); /* Use SvxMarginItem instead of margins from SvxBoxItem, if present. @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ SvxBorderTabPage::SvxBorderTabPage( Window* pParent, is needed across various functions... */ mbUseMarginItem = rCoreAttrs.GetItemState(GetWhich(SID_ATTR_ALIGN_MARGIN),sal_True) != SFX_ITEM_UNKNOWN; - // Metrik einstellen + // set metric FieldUnit eFUnit = GetModuleFieldUnit( rCoreAttrs ); if( mbUseMarginItem ) @@ -201,7 +201,7 @@ SvxBorderTabPage::SvxBorderTabPage( Window* pParent, if ( rCoreAttrs.GetItemState( nWhich, sal_True ) >= SFX_ITEM_AVAILABLE ) { - // Absatz oder Tabelle + // paragraph or table const SvxBoxInfoItem* pBoxInfo = (const SvxBoxInfoItem*)&( rCoreAttrs.Get( nWhich ) ); @@ -272,7 +272,7 @@ SvxBorderTabPage::SvxBorderTabPage( Window* pParent, FillValueSets(); FillLineListBox_Impl(); - // ColorBox aus der XColorList fuellen. + // fill ColorBox out of the XColorList SfxObjectShell* pDocSh = SfxObjectShell::Current(); const SfxPoolItem* pItem = NULL; XColorListRef pColorTable; @@ -290,7 +290,7 @@ SvxBorderTabPage::SvxBorderTabPage( Window* pParent, if ( pColorTable.is() ) { - // fuellen der Linienfarben-Box + // filling the line color box aLbLineColor.SetUpdateMode( sal_False ); for ( long i = 0; i < pColorTable->Count(); ++i ) @@ -299,7 +299,7 @@ SvxBorderTabPage::SvxBorderTabPage( Window* pParent, aLbLineColor.InsertEntry( pEntry->GetColor(), pEntry->GetName() ); } aLbLineColor.SetUpdateMode( sal_True ); - // dann nur noch in die Schattenfarben-Box kopieren + aLbShadowColor.CopyEntries( aLbLineColor ); } FreeResource(); @@ -389,7 +389,7 @@ void SvxBorderTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) ResetFrameLine_Impl( svx::FRAMEBORDER_HOR, pBoxInfoItem->GetHori(), pBoxInfoItem->IsValid( VALID_HORI ) ); //------------------- - // Abstand nach innen + // distance inside //------------------- if( !mbUseMarginItem ) { @@ -435,10 +435,6 @@ void SvxBorderTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) long nBottomDist = pBoxItem->GetDistance( BOX_LINE_BOTTOM); SetMetricValue( aBottomMF, nBottomDist, eCoreUnit ); - // ist der Abstand auf nicht-default gesetzt, - // dann soll der Wert auch nicht - // mehr autom. veraendert werden - // if the distance is set with no active border line // or it is null with an active border line // no automatic changes should be made @@ -474,12 +470,12 @@ void SvxBorderTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) } else { - // ResetFrameLine-Aufrufe einsparen: + // avoid ResetFrameLine-calls: aFrameSel.HideAllBorders(); } //------------------------------------------------------------- - // Linie/Linienfarbe in Controllern darstellen, wenn eindeutig: + // depict line (color) in controllers if unambiguous: //------------------------------------------------------------- { // Do all visible lines show the same line widths? @@ -531,7 +527,7 @@ void SvxBorderTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aWndPresets.SetNoSelection(); - // - keine Line - sollte nicht selektiert sein + // - no line - should not be selected if ( aLbLineStyle.GetSelectEntryPos() == 0 ) { @@ -548,7 +544,7 @@ void SvxBorderTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) sal_uInt16 nHtmlMode = ((SfxUInt16Item*)pItem)->GetValue(); if(nHtmlMode & HTMLMODE_ON) { - //Im Html-Mode gibt es keinen Schatten und nur komplette Umrandungen + // there are no shadows in Html-mode and only complete borders aFtShadowPos .Disable(); aWndShadows .Disable(); aFtShadowSize .Disable(); @@ -606,7 +602,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBorderTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreAttrs ) const SfxPoolItem* pOld = 0; //------------------ - // Umrandung aussen: + // outter border: //------------------ typedef ::std::pair TBorderPair; TBorderPair eTypes1[] = { @@ -620,7 +616,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBorderTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreAttrs ) aBoxItem.SetLine( aFrameSel.GetFrameBorderStyle( eTypes1[i].first ), eTypes1[i].second ); //-------------------------------- - // Umrandung hor/ver und TableFlag + // border hor/ver and TableFlag //-------------------------------- TBorderPair eTypes2[] = { TBorderPair(svx::FRAMEBORDER_HOR,BOXINFO_LINE_HORI), @@ -633,7 +629,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBorderTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreAttrs ) aBoxInfoItem.EnableVer( mbVerEnabled ); //------------------- - // Abstand nach Innen + // inner distance //------------------- if( aLeftMF.IsVisible() ) { @@ -690,7 +686,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBorderTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreAttrs ) } //------------------------------------------ - // Don't Care Status im Info-Item vermerken: + // note Don't Care Status in the Info-Item: //------------------------------------------ aBoxInfoItem.SetValid( VALID_TOP, aFrameSel.GetFrameBorderState( svx::FRAMEBORDER_TOP ) != svx::FRAMESTATE_DONTCARE ); aBoxInfoItem.SetValid( VALID_BOTTOM, aFrameSel.GetFrameBorderState( svx::FRAMEBORDER_BOTTOM ) != svx::FRAMESTATE_DONTCARE ); @@ -700,7 +696,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBorderTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rCoreAttrs ) aBoxInfoItem.SetValid( VALID_VERT, aFrameSel.GetFrameBorderState( svx::FRAMEBORDER_VER ) != svx::FRAMESTATE_DONTCARE ); // - // Put oder Clear der Umrandung? + // Put or Clear of the border? // bPut = sal_True; @@ -1122,10 +1118,10 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBorderTabPage, LinesChanged_Impl) aBottomMF.SetValue(0); } } - //fuer Tabellen ist alles erlaubt + // for tables everything is allowed sal_uInt16 nValid = VALID_TOP|VALID_BOTTOM|VALID_LEFT|VALID_RIGHT; - //fuer Rahmen und Absatz wird das Edit disabled, wenn keine Border gesetzt ist + // for border and paragraph the edit is disabled, if there's no border set if(nSWMode & (SW_BORDER_MODE_FRAME|SW_BORDER_MODE_PARA)) { if(bLineSet) diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/border.hrc b/cui/source/tabpages/border.hrc index 9d5ce879a5d6..6ae3ef00860a 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/border.hrc +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/border.hrc @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ #define CB_MERGEADJACENTBORDERS 66 #define FT_WIDTH 67 -// ImageListe fuer ValueSets: +// ImageList for ValueSets: #define IL_PRE_BITMAPS 1400 #define IID_PRE_CELL_NONE 1 #define IID_PRE_CELL_ALL 2 diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/chardlg.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/chardlg.cxx index f6fb8794e970..c127824b020b 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/chardlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/chardlg.cxx @@ -581,14 +581,14 @@ namespace DBG_ASSERT( _pPage->GetItemSet().GetParent(), "No parent set" ); const SvxFontHeightItem& rOldItem = (SvxFontHeightItem&)_pPage->GetItemSet().GetParent()->Get( _nFontHeightWhich ); - // alter Wert, skaliert + // old value, scaled long nHeight; if ( _pFontSizeLB->IsPtRelative() ) nHeight = rOldItem.GetHeight() + PointToTwips( static_cast(_pFontSizeLB->GetValue() / 10) ); else nHeight = static_cast(rOldItem.GetHeight() * _pFontSizeLB->GetValue() / 100); - // Umrechnung in twips fuer das Beispiel-Window + // conversion twips for the example-window aSize.Height() = ItemToControl( nHeight, _pPage->GetItemSet().GetPool()->GetMetric( _nFontHeightWhich ), SFX_FUNIT_TWIP ); } @@ -665,8 +665,8 @@ void SvxCharNamePage::FillStyleBox_Impl( const FontNameBox* pNameBox ) if ( m_pImpl->m_bInSearchMode ) { - // Bei der Suche zus"atzliche Eintr"age: - // "Nicht Fett" und "Nicht Kursiv" + // additional entries for the search: + // "not bold" and "not italic" String aEntry = m_pImpl->m_aNoStyleText; const sal_Char sS[] = "%1"; aEntry.SearchAndReplaceAscii( sS, pFontList->GetBoldStr() ); @@ -761,11 +761,9 @@ void SvxCharNamePage::Reset_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet, LanguageGroup eLangGrp break; } - // die FontListBox fuellen const FontList* pFontList = GetFontList(); pNameBox->Fill( pFontList ); - // Font ermitteln const SvxFontItem* pFontItem = NULL; SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState( nWhich ); @@ -818,7 +816,7 @@ void SvxCharNamePage::Reset_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet, LanguageGroup eLangGrp bStyle = false; bStyleAvailable = bStyleAvailable && (eState >= SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE); - // Aktuell eingestellter Font + // currently chosen font if ( bStyle && pFontItem ) { FontInfo aInfo = pFontList->Get( pFontItem->GetFamilyName(), eWeight, eItalic ); @@ -839,7 +837,6 @@ void SvxCharNamePage::Reset_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet, LanguageGroup eLangGrp pStyleLabel->Disable( ); } - // SizeBox fuellen FillSizeBox_Impl( pNameBox ); switch ( eLangGrp ) { @@ -1050,7 +1047,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxCharNamePage::FillItemSet_Impl( SfxItemSet& rSet, LanguageGroup eLan if ( nEntryPos >= m_pImpl->m_nExtraEntryPos ) bChanged = ( nEntryPos == m_pImpl->m_nExtraEntryPos ); - String aText( pStyleBox->GetText() ); // Tristate, dann Text leer + String aText( pStyleBox->GetText() ); // Tristate, then text empty if ( bChanged && aText.Len() ) { @@ -1110,7 +1107,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxCharNamePage::FillItemSet_Impl( SfxItemSet& rSet, LanguageGroup eLan // FontSize long nSize = static_cast(pSizeBox->GetValue()); - if ( !pSizeBox->GetText().Len() ) // GetValue() gibt dann Min-Wert zurueck + if ( !pSizeBox->GetText().Len() ) // GetValue() returns the min-value nSize = 0; long nSavedSize = pSizeBox->GetSavedValue().ToInt32(); bool bRel = true; @@ -1377,9 +1374,9 @@ namespace short nCurHeight = static_cast< short >( CalcToPoint( rHeightItem.GetHeight(), eUnit, 1 ) * 10 ); - // ausgehend von der akt. Hoehe: - // - negativ bis minimal 2 pt - // - positiv bis maximal 999 pt + // based on the current height: + // - negative until minimum of 2 pt + // - positive until maximum of 999 pt _pFontSizeLB->EnablePtRelativeMode( sal::static_int_cast< short >(-(nCurHeight - 20)), (9999 - nCurHeight), 10 ); } } @@ -3156,7 +3153,7 @@ void SvxCharPositionPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) m_aLowPosBtn.Check( sal_False ); } - // BspFont setzen + // set BspFont SetPrevFontEscapement( nProp, nEscProp, nEsc ); // Kerning @@ -3171,7 +3168,7 @@ void SvxCharPositionPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) long nBig = static_cast(m_aKerningEdit.Normalize( static_cast(rItem.GetValue()) )); long nKerning = LogicToLogic( nBig, eOrgUnit, ePntUnit ); - // Kerning am Font setzen, vorher in Twips umrechnen + // set Kerning at the Font, convert into Twips before long nKern = LogicToLogic( rItem.GetValue(), (MapUnit)eUnit, MAP_TWIP ); rFont.SetFixKerning( (short)nKern ); rCJKFont.SetFixKerning( (short)nKern ); @@ -3318,7 +3315,7 @@ void SvxCharPositionPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) sal_Bool SvxCharPositionPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) { - // Position (hoch, normal oder tief) + // Position (high, normal or low) const SfxItemSet& rOldSet = GetItemSet(); sal_Bool bModified = sal_False, bChanged = sal_True; sal_uInt16 nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_CHAR_ESCAPEMENT ); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/connect.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/connect.cxx index f20b636b0570..2d47d7c7af57 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/connect.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/connect.cxx @@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ static sal_uInt16 pRanges[] = /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum Aendern von Konnektoren (Connectors) +|* dialog for changing connectors |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ SvxConnectionDialog::~SvxConnectionDialog() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Seite zum Aendern von Konnektoren (Connectors) +|* page for changing connectors |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -176,7 +176,7 @@ SvxConnectionPage::~SvxConnectionPage() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Liest uebergebenen Item-Set +|* reads passed Item-Set |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ void SvxConnectionPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Fuellt uebergebenen Item-Set mit Dialogbox-Attributen +|* fills the passed Item-Set width Dialogbox attributes |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -413,7 +413,7 @@ void SvxConnectionPage::Construct() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Erzeugt die Seite +|* creates the page |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -498,7 +498,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxConnectionPage, ChangeAttrHdl_Impl, void *, p ) if( p == &aLbType ) { - // Anzahl der Linienversaetze ermitteln + // get the number of line displacements sal_uInt16 nCount = aCtlPreview.GetLineDeltaAnz(); aFtLine3.Enable( nCount > 2 ); @@ -535,7 +535,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxConnectionPage, ChangeAttrHdl_Impl, void *, p ) void SvxConnectionPage::FillTypeLB() { - // ListBox mit Verbindernamen fuellen + // fill ListBox with connector names const SfxPoolItem* pItem = GetItem( rOutAttrs, SDRATTR_EDGEKIND ); const SfxItemPool* pPool = rOutAttrs.GetPool(); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/grfpage.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/grfpage.cxx index b2f594068bfb..ae72075aef4c 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/grfpage.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/grfpage.cxx @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ inline long lcl_GetValue( MetricField& rMetric, FieldUnit eUnit ) } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Grafik zuschneiden + description: crop graphic --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ SvxGrfCropPage::SvxGrfCropPage ( Window *pParent, const SfxItemSet &rSet ) @@ -190,7 +190,7 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet &rSet ) nW = rPool.GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE_SIZE ); if ( SFX_ITEM_SET == rSet.GetItemState( nW, sal_False, &pItem ) ) { - // Orientation und Size aus dem PageItem + // orientation and size from the PageItem FieldUnit eUnit = MapToFieldUnit( rSet.GetPool()->GetMetric( nW )); aPageSize = ((const SvxSizeItem*)pItem)->GetSize(); @@ -253,7 +253,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxGrfCropPage::FillItemSet(SfxItemSet &rSet) SvxSizeItem aSz( nW ); - // die Groesse koennte schon von einer anderen Page gesetzt worden sein + // size could already have been set from another page // #44204# const SfxItemSet* pExSet = GetTabDialog() ? GetTabDialog()->GetExampleSet() : NULL; const SfxPoolItem* pItem = 0; @@ -331,8 +331,8 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) { if(!bReset) { - // Wert wurde von Umlauf-Tabpage geaendert und muss - // mit Modify-Flag gesetzt werden + // value was changed by wrap-tabpage and has to + // be set with modify-flag aWidthMF.SetUserValue(nWidth, FUNIT_TWIP); } else @@ -344,8 +344,8 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) { if (!bReset) { - // Wert wurde von Umlauf-Tabpage geaendert und muss - // mit Modify-Flag gesetzt werden + // value was changed by wrap-tabpage and has to + // be set with modify-flag aHeightMF.SetUserValue(nHeight, FUNIT_TWIP); } else @@ -389,7 +389,7 @@ int SvxGrfCropPage::DeactivatePage(SfxItemSet *_pSet) } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Massstab geaendert, Groesse anpassen + description: scale changed, adjust size --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, ZoomHdl, MetricField *, pField ) @@ -420,7 +420,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, ZoomHdl, MetricField *, pField ) } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Groesse aendern, Massstab anpassen + description: change size, adjust scale --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, SizeHdl, MetricField *, pField ) @@ -458,7 +458,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, SizeHdl, MetricField *, pField ) } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Raender auswerten + description: evaluate border --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, CropHdl, const MetricField *, pField ) @@ -494,7 +494,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, CropHdl, const MetricField *, pField ) aExampleWN.SetRight(nRight); if(bZoom) { - //Massstab bleibt -> Breite neu berechnen + // scale stays, recompute width ZoomHdl(&aWidthZoomMF); } } @@ -523,19 +523,19 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxGrfCropPage, CropHdl, const MetricField *, pField ) aExampleWN.SetBottom( nBottom ); if(bZoom) { - //Massstab bleibt -> Hoehe neu berechnen + // scale stays, recompute height ZoomHdl(&aHeightZoomMF); } } aExampleWN.Invalidate(); - //Groesse und Raender veraendert -> Massstab neu berechnen + // size and border changed -> recompute scale if(!bZoom) CalcZoom(); CalcMinMaxBorder(); return 0; } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Originalgroesse einstellen + description: set original size --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGrfCropPage, OrigSizeHdl) @@ -559,7 +559,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGrfCropPage, OrigSizeHdl) return 0; } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Massstab berechnen + description: compute scale --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ void SvxGrfCropPage::CalcZoom() @@ -588,7 +588,7 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::CalcZoom() } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Minimal-/Maximalwerte fuer die Raender setzen + description: set minimum/maximum values for the margins --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ void SvxGrfCropPage::CalcMinMaxBorder() @@ -616,8 +616,8 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::CalcMinMaxBorder() aTopMF.SetMax( aTopMF.Normalize(nMin), eUnit ); } /*-------------------------------------------------------------------- - Beschreibung: Spinsize auf 1/20 der Originalgroesse setzen, - FixedText mit der Originalgroesse fuellen + description: set spinsize to 1/20 of the original size, + fill FixedText with the original size --------------------------------------------------------------------*/ void SvxGrfCropPage::GraphicHasChanged( sal_Bool bFound ) @@ -633,7 +633,7 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::GraphicHasChanged( sal_Bool bFound ) nSpin = MetricField::ConvertValue( nSpin, aOrigSize.Width(), 0, eUnit, aLeftMF.GetUnit()); - // Ist der Rand zu gross, wird er auf beiden Seiten auf 1/3 eingestellt. + // if the margin is too big, it is set to 1/3 on both pages long nR = lcl_GetValue( aRightMF, eUnit ); long nL = lcl_GetValue( aLeftMF, eUnit ); if((nL + nR) < - aOrigSize.Width()) @@ -663,7 +663,7 @@ void SvxGrfCropPage::GraphicHasChanged( sal_Bool bFound ) aTopMF.SetSpinSize(nSpin); aBottomMF.SetSpinSize(nSpin); - //Originalgroesse anzeigen + // display original size const FieldUnit eMetric = GetModuleFieldUnit( GetItemSet() ); MetricField aFld(this, WB_HIDE); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/labdlg.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/labdlg.cxx index fa7384a13574..21cdbf6aae50 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/labdlg.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/labdlg.cxx @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ SvxCaptionTabPage::SvxCaptionTabPage(Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs aFT_WINKEL.Hide(); aLB_WINKEL.Hide(); - //------------Positionen korrigieren------------------------- + //------------correct positions------------------------- aFT_ANSATZ_REL.SetPosPixel( aFT_UM.GetPosPixel() ); aLB_ANSATZ_REL.SetPosPixel( Point( @@ -125,7 +125,7 @@ SvxCaptionTabPage::SvxCaptionTabPage(Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs for( nBitmap = 0; nBitmap < CAPTYPE_BITMAPS_COUNT; nBitmap++ ) mpBmpCapTypes[nBitmap] = new Image(Bitmap(CUI_RES(BMP_CAPTTYPE_1 + nBitmap)), COL_LIGHTMAGENTA ); - //------------ValueSet installieren-------------------------- + //------------install ValueSet-------------------------- aCT_CAPTTYPE.SetStyle( aCT_CAPTTYPE.GetStyle() | WB_ITEMBORDER | WB_DOUBLEBORDER | WB_NAMEFIELD ); aCT_CAPTTYPE.SetColCount(5);//XXX aCT_CAPTTYPE.SetLineCount(1); @@ -158,7 +158,7 @@ SvxCaptionTabPage::~SvxCaptionTabPage() void SvxCaptionTabPage::Construct() { - // Setzen des Rechtecks und der Workingarea + // set rectangle and working area DBG_ASSERT( pView, "Keine gueltige View Uebergeben!" ); } @@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxCaptionTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& _rOutAttrs) _rOutAttrs.Put( SdrCaptionGapItem( GetCoreValue(aMF_ABSTAND, eUnit ) ) ); } - // Sonderbehandlung!!! XXX + // special treatment!!! XXX if( nCaptionType==SDRCAPT_TYPE1 ) { switch( nEscDir ) @@ -229,7 +229,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxCaptionTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& _rOutAttrs) } } -//NYI-------------die Winkel muessen noch hier rein!!! XXX---------------------- +//NYI-------------the angles have to be added here!!! XXX---------------------- return( sal_True ); } @@ -239,7 +239,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxCaptionTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& _rOutAttrs) void SvxCaptionTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) { - //------------Metrik einstellen----------------------------- + //------------set metric----------------------------- FieldUnit eFUnit = GetModuleFieldUnit( rOutAttrs ); @@ -262,29 +262,27 @@ void SvxCaptionTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) sal_uInt16 nWhich; SfxMapUnit eUnit; - //------- Winkel ---------- + //------- angle ---------- nWhich = GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONANGLE ); nFixedAngle = ( ( const SdrCaptionAngleItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( nWhich ) ).GetValue(); - //------- absolute Ansatzentfernung ---------- nWhich = GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONESCABS ); eUnit = pPool->GetMetric( nWhich ); nEscAbs = ( ( const SdrCaptionEscAbsItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( nWhich ) ).GetValue(); SetMetricValue( aMF_ANSATZ, nEscAbs, eUnit ); nEscAbs = static_cast(aMF_ANSATZ.GetValue()); - //------- relative Ansatzentfernung ---------- nWhich = GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONESCREL ); nEscRel = (long)( ( const SdrCaptionEscRelItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( nWhich ) ).GetValue(); - //------- Linienlaenge ---------- + //------- line length ---------- nWhich = GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONLINELEN ); eUnit = pPool->GetMetric( nWhich ); nLineLen = ( ( const SdrCaptionLineLenItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( nWhich ) ).GetValue(); SetMetricValue( aMF_LAENGE, nLineLen, eUnit ); nLineLen = static_cast(aMF_LAENGE.GetValue()); - //------- Abstand zur Box ---------- + //------- distance to box ---------- nWhich = GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONGAP ); eUnit = pPool->GetMetric( nWhich ); nGap = ( ( const SdrCaptionGapItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( nWhich ) ).GetValue(); @@ -297,7 +295,7 @@ void SvxCaptionTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) nEscDir = (short)( ( const SdrCaptionEscDirItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONESCDIR ) ) ).GetValue(); bEscRel = ( ( const SfxBoolItem& ) rOutAttrs.Get( GetWhich( SDRATTR_CAPTIONESCISREL ) ) ).GetValue(); - // Sonderbehandlung!!! XXX + // special treatment!!! XXX if( nCaptionType==SDRCAPT_TYPE1 ) { switch( nEscDir ) @@ -369,7 +367,7 @@ void SvxCaptionTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) aLB_WINKEL.SelectEntryPos( nWinkelTypePos ); SetupAnsatz_Impl( nAnsatzTypePos ); - aCT_CAPTTYPE.SelectItem( nCaptionType+1 );// Enum beginnt bei 0! + aCT_CAPTTYPE.SelectItem( nCaptionType+1 ); // Enum starts at 0! SetupType_Impl( nCaptionType+1 ); } @@ -397,7 +395,7 @@ void SvxCaptionTabPage::SetupAnsatz_Impl( sal_uInt16 nType ) switch( nType ) { case AZ_OPTIMAL: -// aMF_ANSATZ.Hide(); //XXX auch bei OPTIMAL werden Abswerte genommen +// aMF_ANSATZ.Hide(); //XXX in case of OPTIMAL also absolute values are taken // aFT_UM.Hide(); aMF_ANSATZ.Show(); aFT_UM.Show(); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/macroass.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/macroass.cxx index ef344864afef..6edbc68ea22b 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/macroass.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/macroass.cxx @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ static sal_uInt16 aPageRg[] = { 0 }; -// Achtung im Code wird dieses Array direkt (0, 1, ...) indiziert +// attention, this array is indexed directly (0, 1, ...) in the code static long nTabs[] = { 2, // Number of Tabs @@ -151,11 +151,11 @@ String ConvertToUIName_Impl( SvxMacro *pMacro ) void _SfxMacroTabPage::EnableButtons() { - // Solange die Eventbox leer ist, nichts tun + // don't do anything as long as the eventbox is empty const SvLBoxEntry* pE = mpImpl->pEventLB->GetListBox().FirstSelected(); if ( pE ) { - // Gebundenes Macro holen + // get bound macro const SvxMacro* pM = aTbl.Get( (sal_uInt16)(sal_uLong) pE->GetUserData() ); mpImpl->pDeletePB->Enable( 0 != pM && !mpImpl->bReadOnly ); @@ -186,7 +186,7 @@ void _SfxMacroTabPage::AddEvent( const String & rEventName, sal_uInt16 nEventId String sTmp( rEventName ); sTmp += '\t'; - // falls die Tabelle schon gueltig ist + // if the table is valid already SvxMacro* pM = aTbl.Get( nEventId ); if( pM ) { @@ -200,7 +200,7 @@ void _SfxMacroTabPage::AddEvent( const String & rEventName, sal_uInt16 nEventId void _SfxMacroTabPage::ScriptChanged() { - // neue Bereiche und deren Funktionen besorgen + // get new areas and their functions { mpImpl->pGroupLB->Show(); mpImpl->pMacroLB->Show(); @@ -327,7 +327,7 @@ IMPL_STATIC_LINK( _SfxMacroTabPage, AssignDeleteHdl_Impl, PushButton*, pBtn ) const sal_Bool bAssEnabled = pBtn != pImpl->pDeletePB && pImpl->pAssignPB->IsEnabled(); - // aus der Tabelle entfernen + // remove from the table sal_uInt16 nEvent = (sal_uInt16)(sal_uLong)pE->GetUserData(); pThis->aTbl.Erase( nEvent ); @@ -380,7 +380,6 @@ IMPL_STATIC_LINK( _SfxMacroTabPage, TimeOut_Impl, Timer*, EMPTYARG ) void _SfxMacroTabPage::InitAndSetHandler() { - // Handler installieren SvHeaderTabListBox& rListBox = mpImpl->pEventLB->GetListBox(); HeaderBar& rHeaderBar = mpImpl->pEventLB->GetHeaderBar(); Link aLnk(STATIC_LINK(this, _SfxMacroTabPage, AssignDeleteHdl_Impl )); @@ -430,7 +429,7 @@ void _SfxMacroTabPage::FillEvents() sal_uLong nEntryCnt = rListBox.GetEntryCount(); - // Events aus der Tabelle holen und die EventListBox entsprechen fuellen + // get events from the table and fill the EventListBox respectively for( sal_uLong n = 0 ; n < nEntryCnt ; ++n ) { SvLBoxEntry* pE = rListBox.GetEntry( n ); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.cxx index 8f07d6424347..798da335b35e 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.cxx @@ -70,12 +70,12 @@ static sal_uInt16 pRanges[] = }; /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: SvxNumberPreviewImpl +#* Method: SvxNumberPreviewImpl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberPreview -#* Funktion: Konstruktor der Klasse SvxNumberPreviewImpl -#* Input: Fenster, Resource-ID +#* Class: SvxNumberPreview +#* Function: Constructor of the class SvxNumberPreviewImpl +#* Input: Window, Resource-ID #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -94,11 +94,11 @@ SvxNumberPreviewImpl::SvxNumberPreviewImpl( Window* pParent, const ResId& rResId } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: SvxNumberPreviewImpl +#* Method: SvxNumberPreviewImpl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberPreview -#* Funktion: Destruktor der Klasse SvxNumberPreviewImpl +#* Class: SvxNumberPreview +#* Function: Destructor of the class SvxNumberPreviewImpl #* Input: --- #* Output: --- #* @@ -109,12 +109,12 @@ SvxNumberPreviewImpl::~SvxNumberPreviewImpl() } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: NotifyChange +#* Method: NotifyChange #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberPreviewImpl -#* Funktion: Funktion fuer das Aendern des Preview- Strings -#* Input: String, Farbe +#* Class: SvxNumberPreviewImpl +#* Function: Function for changing the preview string +#* Input: String, color #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -131,11 +131,11 @@ void SvxNumberPreviewImpl::NotifyChange( const String& rPrevStr, } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: Paint +#* Method: Paint #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberPreviewImpl -#* Funktion: Funktion fuer das neu zeichnen des Fensters. +#* Class: SvxNumberPreviewImpl +#* Function: Function for repainting the window. #* Input: --- #* Output: --- #* @@ -251,7 +251,7 @@ SvxNumberFormatTabPage::SvxNumberFormatTabPage( Window* pParent, pLastActivWindow( NULL ) { Init_Impl(); - SetExchangeSupport(); // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + SetExchangeSupport(); // this page needs ExchangeSupport FreeResource(); nFixedCategory=-1; } @@ -284,15 +284,14 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Init_Impl() aIbRemove.Enable(sal_False ); aIbInfo.Enable(sal_False ); - aEdComment.SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); //String fuer Benutzerdefiniert - //holen + aEdComment.SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); // string for user defined + aEdComment.Hide(); aCbSourceFormat.Check( sal_False ); aCbSourceFormat.Disable(); aCbSourceFormat.Hide(); -// Handler verbinden Link aLink = LINK( this, SvxNumberFormatTabPage, SelFormatHdl_Impl ); aLbCategory .SetSelectHdl( aLink ); @@ -319,7 +318,7 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Init_Impl() aResetWinTimer .SetTimeoutHdl(LINK( this, SvxNumberFormatTabPage, TimeHdl_Impl)); aResetWinTimer .SetTimeout( 10); - // Sprachen-ListBox initialisieren + // initialize language ListBox aLbLanguage.InsertLanguage( LANGUAGE_SYSTEM ); // Don't list ambiguous locales where we won't be able to convert the @@ -342,13 +341,13 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Init_Impl() } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: GetRanges +#* Method: GetRanges #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Liefert Bereichsangaben zurueck. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Returns area information. #* Input: --- -#* Output: Bereich +#* Output: area #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -359,13 +358,13 @@ sal_uInt16* SvxNumberFormatTabPage::GetRanges() /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: Create +#* Method: Create #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Erzeugt eine neue Zahlenformat- Seite. -#* Input: Fenster, SfxItemSet -#* Output: neue TabPage +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Creates a new number format page. +#* Input: Window, SfxItemSet +#* Output: new TabPage #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -377,12 +376,12 @@ SfxTabPage* SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Create( Window* pParent, /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: Reset +#* Method: Reset #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Die Attribute des Dialogs werden mit Hilfe -#* des Itemsets neu eingestellt. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: The dialog's attributes are reset +#* using the Itemset. #* Input: SfxItemSet #* Output: --- #* @@ -476,10 +475,9 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aCbSourceFormat.Show( bInit ); } - // pNumItem muss von aussen gesetzt worden sein! + // pNumItem must have been set from outside! DBG_ASSERT( pNumItem, "No NumberInfo, no NumberFormatter, good bye.CRASH. :-(" ); - // aktuellen Zahlenformat-Tabellenindex holen eState = rSet.GetItemState( GetWhich( SID_ATTR_NUMBERFORMAT_VALUE ) ); if ( SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE != eState ) @@ -503,13 +501,11 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) break; } - // nun sind alle Informationen fuer die Formatierer-Shell beisammen: - if ( pNumFmtShell ) - delete pNumFmtShell; // ggF. alte Shell loeschen (==Reset) + delete pNumFmtShell; // delete old shell if applicable (== reset) - nInitFormat = ( pValFmtAttr ) // Init-Key merken - ? pValFmtAttr->GetValue() // (fuer FillItemSet()) + nInitFormat = ( pValFmtAttr ) // memorize init key + ? pValFmtAttr->GetValue() // (for FillItemSet()) : ULONG_MAX; // == DONT_KNOW @@ -576,7 +572,7 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) } else // DONT_KNOW { - // Kategoriewechsel und direkte Eingabe sind moeglich, sonst nix: + // everything disabled except direct input or changing the category Obstructing(); } @@ -590,12 +586,12 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: Obstructing +#* Method: Obstructing #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Sperren der Controls mit Ausnahme von Kategoriewechsel -#* und direkter Eingabe. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Disable the controls except from changing the category +#* and direct input. #* Input: --- #* Output: --- #* @@ -627,8 +623,7 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::Obstructing() aLbCategory .SelectEntryPos( 0 ); aEdFormat .SetText( String() ); aFtComment .SetText( String() ); - aEdComment .SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); //String fuer Benutzerdefiniert - //holen + aEdComment .SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); // string for user defined aEdFormat .GrabFocus(); } @@ -669,11 +664,11 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::EnableBySourceFormat_Impl() /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: HideLanguage +#* Method: HideLanguage #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Versteckt die Spracheinstellung: +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Hides the language settings: #* Input: sal_Bool nFlag #* Output: --- #* @@ -699,13 +694,13 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::HideLanguage(sal_Bool nFlag) } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: FillItemSet +#* Method: FillItemSet #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Stellt die Attribute im ItemSet ein, -#* sowie in der DocShell den numItem, wenn -#* bNumItemFlag nicht gesetzt ist. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Adjusts the attributes in the ItemSet, +#* and - if bNumItemFlag is not set - the +#* numItem in the DocShell. #* Input: SfxItemSet #* Output: --- #* @@ -906,13 +901,13 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::DeleteEntryList_Impl( std::vector& rEntrie /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: UpdateOptions_Impl +#* Method: UpdateOptions_Impl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Stellt je nach eingestelltem Format die Options- -#* attribute neu ein. -#* Input: Flag, ob sich die Kategorie geaendert hat. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Adjusts the options attributes +#* depending on the selected format. +#* Input: Flag, whether the category has changed. #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -1018,22 +1013,22 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::UpdateOptions_Impl( sal_Bool bCheckCatChange /*= sa /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: UpdateFormatListBox_Impl +#* Method: UpdateFormatListBox_Impl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Aktualisiert die Format- Listbox und zusaetzlich -#* wird abhaengig vom bUpdateEdit- Flag der String -#* in der Editbox geaendert. -#* Input: Flags fuer Kategorie und Editbox +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Updates the format lisbox and additionally the +#* string in the editbox is changed depending on +#* the bUpdateEdit flag. +#* Input: Flags for category and editbox. #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::UpdateFormatListBox_Impl ( - sal_uInt16 bCat, // Category oder Land/Sprache ListBox? - sal_Bool bUpdateEdit // Format-Edit aktualisieren? + sal_uInt16 bCat, // Category or country/language ListBox? + sal_Bool bUpdateEdit ) { std::vector aEntryList; @@ -1076,7 +1071,7 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::UpdateFormatListBox_Impl pNumFmtShell->LanguageChanged( aLbLanguage.GetSelectLanguage(), nFmtLbSelPos,aEntryList ); - REMOVE_DONTKNOW() // ggF. UI-Enable + REMOVE_DONTKNOW() // possibly UI-Enable if ( (!aEntryList.empty()) && (nFmtLbSelPos != SELPOS_NONE) ) @@ -1141,11 +1136,10 @@ void SvxNumberFormatTabPage::UpdateFormatListBox_Impl #* Handle: DoubleClickHdl_Impl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Bei einem Doppelklick in die Format- Listbox -#* wird der Wert uebernommen und der OK-Button -#* ausgeloest -#* Input: Pointer auf Listbox +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: On a double click in the format lisbox the +#* value is adopted and the OK button pushed. +#* Input: Pointer on the Listbox #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -1157,7 +1151,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, DoubleClickHdl_Impl, SvxFontListBox*, pLb ) SelFormatHdl_Impl( pLb ); if ( fnOkHdl.IsSet() ) - { // Uebergangsloesung, sollte von SfxTabPage angeboten werden + { // temporary solution, should be offered by SfxTabPage fnOkHdl.Call( NULL ); } else @@ -1173,14 +1167,13 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, DoubleClickHdl_Impl, SvxFontListBox*, pLb ) /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: SelFormatHdl_Impl +#* Method: SelFormatHdl_Impl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Wird aufgerufen, wenn sich die Sprache, die Kategorie -#* oder das Format aendert. Dem entsprechend werden die -#* Einstellungen geaendert. -#* Input: Pointer auf Listbox +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Is called when the language, the category or the format +#* is changed. Accordingly the settings are adjusted. +#* Input: Pointer on the Listbox #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -1251,7 +1244,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, SelFormatHdl_Impl, void *, pLb ) ChangePreviewText( nSelPos ); } - REMOVE_DONTKNOW() // ggF. UI-Enable + REMOVE_DONTKNOW() // possibly UI-Enable if ( pNumFmtShell->FindEntry( aFormat) ) { @@ -1275,7 +1268,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, SelFormatHdl_Impl, void *, pLb ) } //-------------------------------------------------------------------- - // Kategorie-ListBox ------------------------------------------------- + // category-ListBox ------------------------------------------------- if ( pLb == &aLbCategory || pLb == &aLbCurrency) { UpdateFormatListBox_Impl( sal_True, sal_True ); @@ -1286,7 +1279,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, SelFormatHdl_Impl, void *, pLb ) } //-------------------------------------------------------------------- - // Sprache/Land-ListBox ---------------------------------------------- + // language/country-ListBox ---------------------------------------------- if ( pLb == &aLbLanguage ) { UpdateFormatListBox_Impl( sal_False, sal_True ); @@ -1299,13 +1292,12 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, SelFormatHdl_Impl, void *, pLb ) /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: ClickHdl_Impl, ImageButton* pIB +#* Method: ClickHdl_Impl, ImageButton* pIB #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Wenn, der Hinzufuegen- oder Entfernen- Button -#* wird diese Funktion aufgerufen und die Zahlenformat- -#* Liste den entsprechend geaendert. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Called when the add or delete button is pushed, +#* adjusts the number format list. #* Input: Toolbox- Button #* Output: --- #* @@ -1372,7 +1364,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, ClickHdl_Impl, ImageButton*, pIB) { if ( bAdded && (nFmtLbSelPos != SELPOS_NONE) ) { - // Alles klar + // everything alright if(bOneAreaFlag) //@@ ??? SetCategory(0); else @@ -1392,13 +1384,13 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, ClickHdl_Impl, ImageButton*, pIB) aLbFormat.SelectEntryPos( (sal_uInt16)nFmtLbSelPos ); aEdFormat.SetText( aFormat ); - aEdComment.SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); //String fuer Benutzerdefiniert - //holen + aEdComment.SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); // String for user defined + ChangePreviewText( (sal_uInt16)nFmtLbSelPos ); } } } - else // Syntaxfehler + else // syntax error { aEdFormat.GrabFocus(); aEdFormat.SetSelection( Selection( (short)nErrPos, SELECTION_MAX ) ); @@ -1444,7 +1436,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, ClickHdl_Impl, ImageButton*, pIB) } else { - // auf "Alle/Standard" setzen + // set to "all/standard" SetCategory(0 ); SelFormatHdl_Impl( &aLbCategory ); } @@ -1475,13 +1467,13 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, ClickHdl_Impl, ImageButton*, pIB) /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: EditHdl_Impl +#* Method: EditHdl_Impl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Wenn der Eintrag im Eingabefeld geaendert wird, -#* so wird die Vorschau aktualisiert und -#* Input: Pointer auf Editbox +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: When the entry in the edit field is changed +#* the preview is updated and +#* Input: Pointer on Editbox #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ @@ -1545,11 +1537,11 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, EditHdl_Impl, Edit*, pEdFormat ) /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: NotifyChange +#* Method: NotifyChange #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Fuehrt Aenderungen in den Zahlen- Attributen durch. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Does changes in the number attributes. #* Input: Options- Controls #* Output: --- #* @@ -1608,11 +1600,11 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxNumberFormatTabPage, TimeHdl_Impl) /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: LostFocusHdl_Impl +#* Method: LostFocusHdl_Impl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Fuehrt Aenderungen in den Zahlen- Attributen durch. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Does changes in the number attributes. #* Input: Options- Controls #* Output: --- #* @@ -1631,19 +1623,18 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumberFormatTabPage, LostFocusHdl_Impl, Edit *, pEd) sal_uInt16 nSelPos = (sal_uInt16) aLbFormat.GetSelectEntryPos(); pNumFmtShell->SetComment4Entry(nSelPos, aEdComment.GetText()); - aEdComment.SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); //String fuer Benutzerdefiniert - //holen + aEdComment.SetText(aLbCategory.GetEntry(1)); // String for user defined } } return 0; } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: NotifyChange +#* Method: NotifyChange #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Fuehrt Aenderungen in den Zahlen- Attributen durch. +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Does changes in the number attributes. #* Input: Options- Controls #* Output: --- #* @@ -1713,12 +1704,12 @@ long SvxNumberFormatTabPage::PreNotify( NotifyEvent& rNEvt ) return SfxTabPage::PreNotify( rNEvt ); } /************************************************************************* -#* Methode: SetOkHdl +#* Method: SetOkHdl #*------------------------------------------------------------------------ #* -#* Klasse: SvxNumberFormatTabPage -#* Funktion: Setzt den OkHandler neu. -#* Input: Neuer OkHandler +#* Class: SvxNumberFormatTabPage +#* Function: Resets the OkHandler. +#* Input: new OkHandler #* Output: --- #* #************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.hrc b/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.hrc index 6b72d486af41..763dd59f752d 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.hrc +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/numfmt.hrc @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ // defines ------------------------------------------------------------------ //================================================ -// Zahlen-TabPage: +// number TabPage: #define WND_NUMBER_PREVIEW 2 #define FT_CATEGORY 3 #define FT_FORMAT 4 diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/numpages.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/numpages.cxx index bf9b1f243aca..0b4dfa18d22f 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/numpages.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/numpages.cxx @@ -144,7 +144,7 @@ SvxNumSettings_ImplPtr lcl_CreateNumSettingsPtr(const Sequence& r return pNew; } -// Die Auswahl an Bullets aus den StarSymbol +// the selection of bullets from the StarSymbol static const sal_Unicode aBulletTypes[] = { 0x2022, @@ -167,7 +167,7 @@ static sal_Char const aNumChar[] = ' ' }; -// Ist eins der maskierten Formate gesetzt? +// Is one of the masked formats set? sal_Bool lcl_IsNumFmtSet(SvxNumRule* pNum, sal_uInt16 nLevelMask) { sal_Bool bRet = sal_False; @@ -302,7 +302,7 @@ void SvxSingleNumPickTabPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) *pActNum = *pSaveNum; pExamplesVS->SetNoSelection(); } - // ersten Eintrag vorselektieren + if(pActNum && (!lcl_IsNumFmtSet(pActNum, nActNumLvl) || bIsPreset)) { pExamplesVS->SelectItem(1); @@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ void SvxSingleNumPickTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - //im Draw gibt es das Item als WhichId, im Writer nur als SlotId + // in Draw the item exists as WhichId, in Writer only as SlotId SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState(SID_ATTR_NUMBERING_RULE, sal_False, &pItem); if(eState != SFX_ITEM_SET) { @@ -466,7 +466,7 @@ void SvxBulletPickTabPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) *pActNum = *pSaveNum; pExamplesVS->SetNoSelection(); } - // ersten Eintrag vorselektieren + if(pActNum && (!lcl_IsNumFmtSet(pActNum, nActNumLvl) || bIsPreset)) { pExamplesVS->SelectItem(1); @@ -487,7 +487,7 @@ int SvxBulletPickTabPage::DeactivatePage(SfxItemSet *_pSet) void SvxBulletPickTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - //im Draw gibt es das Item als WhichId, im Writer nur als SlotId + // in Draw the item exists as WhichId, in Writer only as SlotId SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState(SID_ATTR_NUMBERING_RULE, sal_False, &pItem); if(eState != SFX_ITEM_SET) { @@ -669,7 +669,7 @@ void SvxNumPickTabPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) *pActNum = *pSaveNum; pExamplesVS->SetNoSelection(); } - // ersten Eintrag vorselektieren + if(pActNum && (!lcl_IsNumFmtSet(pActNum, nActNumLvl) || bIsPreset)) { pExamplesVS->SelectItem(1); @@ -690,7 +690,7 @@ int SvxNumPickTabPage::DeactivatePage(SfxItemSet *_pSet) void SvxNumPickTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - //im Draw gibt es das Item als WhichId, im Writer nur als SlotId + // in Draw the item exists as WhichId, in Writer only as SlotId SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState(SID_ATTR_NUMBERING_RULE, sal_False, &pItem); if(eState != SFX_ITEM_SET) { @@ -715,7 +715,7 @@ void SvxNumPickTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) } -// Hier werden alle Ebenen veraendert +// all levels are changed here IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxNumPickTabPage, NumSelectHdl_Impl) { if(pActNum) @@ -842,7 +842,7 @@ SvxBitmapPickTabPage::SvxBitmapPickTabPage(Window* pParent, pExamplesVS->SetDoubleClickHdl(LINK(this, SvxBitmapPickTabPage, DoubleClickHdl_Impl)); aLinkedCB.SetClickHdl(LINK(this, SvxBitmapPickTabPage, LinkBmpHdl_Impl)); - // Grafiknamen ermitteln + // determine graphic name GalleryExplorer::FillObjList(GALLERY_THEME_BULLETS, aGrfNames); pExamplesVS->SetHelpId(HID_VALUESET_NUMBMP ); @@ -907,7 +907,7 @@ void SvxBitmapPickTabPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) *pActNum = *pSaveNum; pExamplesVS->SetNoSelection(); } - // ersten Eintrag vorselektieren + if(!aGrfNames.empty() && (pActNum && (!lcl_IsNumFmtSet(pActNum, nActNumLvl) || bIsPreset))) { @@ -945,7 +945,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxBitmapPickTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) void SvxBitmapPickTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - //im Draw gibt es das Item als WhichId, im Writer nur als SlotId + // in Draw the item exists as WhichId, in Writer only as SlotId SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState(SID_ATTR_NUMBERING_RULE, sal_False, &pItem); if(eState != SFX_ITEM_SET) { @@ -1039,7 +1039,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapPickTabPage, LinkBmpHdl_Impl) return 0; } -// Tabpage Numerierungsoptionen +// tabpage numeration options #define NUM_NO_GRAPHIC 1000 SvxNumOptionsTabPage::SvxNumOptionsTabPage(Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rSet) : @@ -1277,7 +1277,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxNumOptionsTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - //im Draw gibt es das Item als WhichId, im Writer nur als SlotId + // in Draw the item exists as WhichId, in Writer only as SlotId SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState(SID_ATTR_NUMBERING_RULE, sal_False, &pItem); if(eState != SFX_ITEM_SET) { @@ -1295,7 +1295,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) delete pSaveNum; pSaveNum = new SvxNumRule(*((SvxNumBulletItem*)pItem)->GetNumRule()); - // Ebenen einfuegen + // insert levels if(!aLevelLB.GetEntryCount()) { for(sal_uInt16 i = 1; i <= pSaveNum->GetLevelCount(); i++) @@ -1336,7 +1336,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) pPreviewWIN->SetNumRule(pActNum); aSameLevelCB.Check(pActNum->IsContinuousNumbering()); - //ColorListBox bei Bedarf fuellen + // fill ColorListBox as needed if ( pActNum->IsFeatureSupported( NUM_BULLET_COLOR ) ) { SfxObjectShell* pDocSh = SfxObjectShell::Current(); @@ -1382,7 +1382,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aSameLevelFL.Show(bContinuous); aSameLevelCB.Show(bContinuous); - //wieder Missbrauch: im Draw gibt es die Numerierung nur bis zum Bitmap + // again misusage: in Draw there is numeration only until the bitmap // without SVX_NUM_NUMBER_NONE //remove types that are unsupported by Draw/Impress if(!bContinuous) @@ -1421,8 +1421,8 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aAlignLB.SetSelectHdl(LINK(this, SvxNumOptionsTabPage, EditModifyHdl_Impl)); } - //MegaHack: Aufgrund eines nicht fixbaren 'designfehlers' im Impress - //Alle arten der numerischen Aufzaehlungen loeschen + // MegaHack: because of a not-fixable 'design mistake/error' in Impress + // delete all kinds of numeric enumerations if(pActNum->IsFeatureSupported(NUM_NO_NUMBERS)) { sal_uInt16 nFmtCount = aFmtLB.GetEntryCount(); @@ -1514,7 +1514,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::InitControls() else aOrientLB.SelectEntryPos( sal::static_int_cast< sal_uInt16 >(eFirstOrient - 1)); - // kein text::VertOrientation::NONE + // no text::VertOrientation::NONE if(bSameSize) { @@ -1548,7 +1548,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::InitControls() } if(bSameAdjust) { - sal_uInt16 nPos = 1; // zentriert + sal_uInt16 nPos = 1; // centered if(aNumFmtArr[nLvl]->GetNumAdjust() == SVX_ADJUST_LEFT) nPos = 0; else if(aNumFmtArr[nLvl]->GetNumAdjust() == SVX_ADJUST_RIGHT) @@ -1613,7 +1613,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::InitControls() pPreviewWIN->Invalidate(); } -// 0 - Nummer; 1 - Bullet; 2 - Bitmap +// 0 - Number; 1 - Bullet; 2 - Bitmap void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::SwitchNumberType( sal_uInt8 nType, sal_Bool ) { if(nBullet == nType) @@ -1624,13 +1624,13 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::SwitchNumberType( sal_uInt8 nType, sal_Bool ) sal_Bool bEnableBitmap = sal_False; if(nType == SHOW_NUMBERING) { - // Label umschalten, alten Text merken + // switch label, memorize old text aStartFT.SetText(sStartWith); } else if(nType == SHOW_BULLET) { - // Label umschalten, alten Text merken + // switch label, memorize old text aStartFT.SetText(sBullet); bBullet = sal_True; } @@ -1649,8 +1649,8 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::SwitchNumberType( sal_uInt8 nType, sal_Bool ) aCharFmtFT.Show(!bBitmap && bCharFmt); aCharFmtLB.Show(!bBitmap && bCharFmt); - // das ist eigentlich Missbrauch, da fuer die vollst. Numerierung kein - // eigenes Flag existiert + // this is rather misusage, as there is no own flag + // for complete numeration sal_Bool bAllLevelFeature = pActNum->IsFeatureSupported(NUM_CONTINUOUS); sal_Bool bAllLevel = bNumeric && bAllLevelFeature && !bHTMLMode; aAllLevelFT.Show(bAllLevel); @@ -1769,7 +1769,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumOptionsTabPage, NumberTypeSelectHdl_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) if(nActNumLvl & nMask) { SvxNumberFormat aNumFmt(pActNum->GetLevel(i)); - // PAGEDESC gibt es nicht + // PAGEDESC does not exist sal_uInt16 nNumType = (sal_uInt16)(sal_uLong)pBox->GetEntryData(pBox->GetSelectEntryPos()); aNumFmt.SetNumberingType((sal_Int16)nNumType); sal_uInt16 nNumberingType = aNumFmt.GetNumberingType(); @@ -1796,7 +1796,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumOptionsTabPage, NumberTypeSelectHdl_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) aNumFmt.SetBulletChar( SVX_DEF_BULLET ); pActNum->SetLevel(i, aNumFmt); SwitchNumberType(SHOW_BULLET); - // Zuweisung der Zeichenvorlage automatisch + // allocation of the drawing pattern is automatic if(bAutomaticCharStyles) { sSelectStyle = sBulletCharFmtName; @@ -1810,7 +1810,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumOptionsTabPage, NumberTypeSelectHdl_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) pActNum->SetLevel(i, aNumFmt); CheckForStartValue_Impl(nNumberingType); - // Zuweisung der Zeichenvorlage automatisch + // allocation of the drawing pattern is automatic if(bAutomaticCharStyles) { sSelectStyle = sNumCharFmtName; @@ -1854,7 +1854,7 @@ void SvxNumOptionsTabPage::CheckForStartValue_Impl(sal_uInt16 nNumberingType) IMPL_LINK( SvxNumOptionsTabPage, OrientHdl_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) { sal_uInt16 nPos = pBox->GetSelectEntryPos(); - nPos ++; // kein VERT_NONE + nPos ++; // no VERT_NONE sal_uInt16 nMask = 1; for(sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < pActNum->GetLevelCount(); i++) @@ -1963,7 +1963,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumOptionsTabPage, GraphicHdl_Impl, MenuButton *, pButton ) aGrfDlg.AsLink( sal_False ); if ( !aGrfDlg.Execute() ) { - // ausgewaehlten Filter merken + // memorize selected filter aGrfName = aGrfDlg.GetPath(); Graphic aGraphic; @@ -1987,7 +1987,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumOptionsTabPage, GraphicHdl_Impl, MenuButton *, pButton ) aNumFmt.SetCharFmtName(sNumCharFmtName); aNumFmt.SetGraphic(aGrfName); - // Size schon mal fuer spaeteren Groessenabgleich setzen + // set size for a later comparison const SvxBrushItem* pBrushItem = aNumFmt.GetBrush(); // initiate asynchronous loading sal_Int16 eOrient = aNumFmt.GetVertOrient(); @@ -2107,7 +2107,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxNumOptionsTabPage, BulletHdl_Impl) pMap->SetChar( cBullet ); if(pMap->Execute() == RET_OK) { - // Font Numrules umstellen + // change Font Numrules aActBulletFont = pMap->GetCharFont(); sal_uInt16 _nMask = 1; @@ -2301,14 +2301,14 @@ sal_uInt16 lcl_DrawBullet(VirtualDevice* pVDev, { Font aTmpFont(pVDev->GetFont()); - //per Uno kann es sein, dass kein Font gesetzt ist! + // via Uno it's possible that no font has been set! Font aFont(rFmt.GetBulletFont() ? *rFmt.GetBulletFont() : aTmpFont); Size aTmpSize(rSize); aTmpSize.Width() *= rFmt.GetBulletRelSize(); aTmpSize.Width() /= 100 ; aTmpSize.Height() *= rFmt.GetBulletRelSize(); aTmpSize.Height() /= 100 ; - // bei einer Hoehe von Null wird in Ursprungshoehe gezeichnet + // in case of a height of zero it is drawed in original height if(!aTmpSize.Height()) aTmpSize.Height() = 1; aFont.SetSize(aTmpSize); @@ -2330,7 +2330,7 @@ sal_uInt16 lcl_DrawBullet(VirtualDevice* pVDev, return nRet; } -// Vorschau der Numerierung painten +// paint preview of numeration void SvxNumberingPreview::Paint( const Rectangle& /*rRect*/ ) { Size aSize(PixelToLogic(GetOutputSizePixel())); @@ -2364,14 +2364,14 @@ void SvxNumberingPreview::Paint( const Rectangle& /*rRect*/ ) nWidthRelation = nWidthRelation / 4; } else - nWidthRelation = 30; // Kapiteldialog + nWidthRelation = 30; // chapter dialog - //Hoehe pro Ebene + // height per level sal_uInt16 nXStep = sal::static_int_cast< sal_uInt16 >(aSize.Width() / (3 * pActNum->GetLevelCount())); if(pActNum->GetLevelCount() < 10) nXStep /= 2; sal_uInt16 nYStart = 4; - // fuer ein einziges Level darf nicht die gesamte Hoehe benutzt werden + // the whole height mustn't be used for a single level sal_uInt16 nYStep = sal::static_int_cast< sal_uInt16 >((aSize.Height() - 6)/ (pActNum->GetLevelCount() > 1 ? pActNum->GetLevelCount() : 5)); aStdFont = OutputDevice::GetDefaultFont( DEFAULTFONT_UI_SANS, MsLangId::getSystemLanguage(), DEFAULTFONT_FLAGS_ONLYONE); @@ -2416,7 +2416,7 @@ void SvxNumberingPreview::Paint( const Rectangle& /*rRect*/ ) nNumberXPos = nNumberXPos - nFirstLineOffset; else nNumberXPos = 0; - //im draw ist das zulaeesig + // in draw this is valid if(nTextOffset < 0) nNumberXPos = nNumberXPos + nTextOffset; } @@ -2883,7 +2883,7 @@ void SvxNumPositionTabPage::InitControls() if(bSameAdjust) { - sal_uInt16 nPos = 1; // zentriert + sal_uInt16 nPos = 1; // centered if(aNumFmtArr[nLvl]->GetNumAdjust() == SVX_ADJUST_LEFT) nPos = 0; else if(aNumFmtArr[nLvl]->GetNumAdjust() == SVX_ADJUST_RIGHT) @@ -3030,7 +3030,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxNumPositionTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) void SvxNumPositionTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - //im Draw gibt es das Item als WhichId, im Writer nur als SlotId + // in Draw the item exists as WhichId, in Writer only as SlotId SfxItemState eState = rSet.GetItemState(SID_ATTR_NUMBERING_RULE, sal_False, &pItem); if(eState != SFX_ITEM_SET) { @@ -3048,7 +3048,7 @@ void SvxNumPositionTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) delete pSaveNum; pSaveNum = new SvxNumRule(*((SvxNumBulletItem*)pItem)->GetNumRule()); - // Ebenen einfuegen + // insert levels if(!aLevelLB.GetEntryCount()) { for(sal_uInt16 i = 1; i <= pSaveNum->GetLevelCount(); i++) @@ -3291,7 +3291,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxNumPositionTabPage, DistanceHdl_Impl, MetricField *, pFld ) } else if(pFld == &aIndentMF) { - //jetzt muss mit dem FirstLineOffset auch der AbsLSpace veraendert werden + // together with the FirstLineOffset the AbsLSpace must be changed, too long nDiff = nValue + aNumFmt.GetFirstLineOffset(); long nAbsLSpace = aNumFmt.GetAbsLSpace(); aNumFmt.SetAbsLSpace(sal_uInt16(nAbsLSpace + nDiff)); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/page.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/page.cxx index a0b5cc87d160..efa495bd26e8 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/page.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/page.cxx @@ -72,8 +72,8 @@ // static ---------------------------------------------------------------- -static const long MINBODY = 284; // 0,5cm in twips aufgerundet -//static const long PRINT_OFFSET = 17; // 0,03cm in twips abgerundet +static const long MINBODY = 284; // 0,5 cm rounded up in twips +//static const long PRINT_OFFSET = 17; // 0,03 cm rounded down in twips static const long PRINT_OFFSET = 0; // why was this ever set to 17 ? it led to wrong right and bottom margins. static sal_uInt16 pRanges[] = @@ -87,7 +87,7 @@ static sal_uInt16 pRanges[] = 0 }; -// ------- Mapping Seitenlayout ------------------------------------------ +// ------- Mapping page layout ------------------------------------------ sal_uInt16 aArr[] = { @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ SvxPageDescPage::SvxPageDescPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rAttr ) : FreeResource(); aBspWin.EnableRTL( sal_False ); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); SvtLanguageOptions aLangOptions; @@ -304,13 +304,13 @@ SvxPageDescPage::SvxPageDescPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rAttr ) : MapMode aOldMode = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetMapMode(); pImpl->mpDefPrinter->SetMapMode( MAP_TWIP ); - // First- und Last-Werte f"ur die R"ander setzen + // set first- and last-values for the margins Size aPaperSize = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetPaperSize(); Size aPrintSize = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetOutputSize(); /* - * einen Punkt ( 0,0 ) in logische Koordinaten zu konvertieren, - * sieht aus wie Unsinn; ist aber sinnvoll, wenn der Ursprung des - * Koordinatensystems verschoben ist. + * To convert a point ( 0,0 ) into logic coordinates + * looks like nonsense; but it makes sense when the + * coordinate system's origin has been moved. */ Point aPrintOffset = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetPageOffset() - pImpl->mpDefPrinter->PixelToLogic( Point() ); @@ -378,7 +378,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Init_Impl() aLeftText = aLeftMarginLbl.GetText(); aRightText = aRightMarginLbl.GetText(); - // Handler einstellen + // adjust the handler aLayoutBox.SetSelectHdl( LINK( this, SvxPageDescPage, LayoutHdl_Impl ) ); aPaperSizeBox.SetDropDownLineCount(10); @@ -422,7 +422,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool" ); SfxMapUnit eUnit = pPool->GetMetric( GetWhich( SID_ATTR_LRSPACE ) ); - // R"ander (Links/Rechts) einstellen + // adjust margins (right/left) const SfxPoolItem* pItem = GetItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_LRSPACE ); if ( pItem ) @@ -436,7 +436,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) (sal_uInt16)ConvertLong_Impl( (long)rLRSpace.GetRight(), eUnit ) ); } - // R"ander (Oben/Unten) einstellen + // adjust margins (top/bottom) pItem = GetItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_ULSPACE ); if ( pItem ) @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) (sal_uInt16)ConvertLong_Impl( (long)rULSpace.GetLower(), eUnit ) ); } - // allgemeine Seitendaten + // general page data SvxNumType eNumType = SVX_ARABIC; bLandscape = ( pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetOrientation() == ORIENTATION_LANDSCAPE ); sal_uInt16 nUse = (sal_uInt16)SVX_PAGE_ALL; @@ -464,15 +464,14 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) bLandscape = rItem.IsLandscape(); } - // Ausrichtung + // alignment aLayoutBox.SelectEntryPos( ::PageUsageToPos_Impl( nUse ) ); aBspWin.SetUsage( nUse ); LayoutHdl_Impl( 0 ); - // Numerierungsart der Seitenvorlage einstellen + // adjust numeration type of the page style aNumberFormatBox.SelectEntryPos( sal::static_int_cast< sal_uInt16 >(eNumType) ); - // Aktueller Papierschacht aPaperTrayBox.Clear(); sal_uInt8 nPaperBin = PAPERBIN_PRINTER_SETTINGS; pItem = GetItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_PAGE_PAPERBIN ); @@ -496,7 +495,6 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aPaperTrayBox.SetEntryData( nEntryPos, (void*)(sal_uLong)nPaperBin ); aPaperTrayBox.SelectEntry( aBinName ); - // Size rausholen Size aPaperSize = SvxPaperInfo::GetPaperSize( pImpl->mpDefPrinter ); pItem = GetItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_PAGE_SIZE ); @@ -529,7 +527,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) if ( bLandscape ) Swap( aPaperSize ); - // Werte in die Edits eintragen + // write values into the edits SetMetricValue( aPaperHeightEdit, aPaperSize.Height(), SFX_MAPUNIT_100TH_MM ); SetMetricValue( aPaperWidthEdit, aPaperSize.Width(), SFX_MAPUNIT_100TH_MM ); aPaperSizeBox.Clear(); @@ -558,7 +556,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) // preselect current paper format - #115915#: ePaper might not be in aPaperSizeBox so use PAPER_USER instead aPaperSizeBox.SelectEntryPos( nActPos != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND ? nActPos : nUserPos ); - // Applikationsspezifisch + // application specific switch ( eMode ) { @@ -569,17 +567,17 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aVertBox.Show(); DisableVerticalPageDir(); - // Horizontale Ausrichtung + // horizontal alignment pItem = GetItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_PAGE_EXT1 ); aHorzBox.Check( pItem ? ( (const SfxBoolItem*)pItem )->GetValue() : sal_False ); - // Vertikale Ausrichtung + // vertical alignment pItem = GetItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_PAGE_EXT2 ); aVertBox.Check( pItem ? ( (const SfxBoolItem*)pItem )->GetValue() : sal_False ); - // Beispiel-Fenster auf Tabelle setzen + // set example window on the table aBspWin.SetTable( sal_True ); aBspWin.SetHorz( aHorzBox.IsChecked() ); aBspWin.SetVert( aVertBox.IsChecked() ); @@ -595,7 +593,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aAdaptBox.Check( pItem ? ( (const SfxBoolItem*)pItem )->GetValue() : sal_False ); - //!!! hidden, weil von StarDraw nicht implementiert + //!!! hidden, because not implemented by StarDraw aLayoutBox.Hide(); aPageText.Hide(); @@ -605,20 +603,17 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) } - // im Beispiel Hintergrund und Umrandung anzeigen + // display background and border in the example ResetBackground_Impl( rSet ); //! UpdateExample_Impl(); RangeHdl_Impl( 0 ); - // Header Footer anzeigen InitHeadFoot_Impl( rSet ); - // R"ander auf Hoch/Quer updaten, dann Beispiel updaten bBorderModified = sal_False; SwapFirstValues_Impl( sal_False ); UpdateExample_Impl(); - // Alte Werte sichern aLeftMarginEdit.SaveValue(); aRightMarginEdit.SaveValue(); aTopMarginEdit.SaveValue(); @@ -637,7 +632,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) CheckMarginEdits( true ); - // Registerhaltigkeit + if(SFX_ITEM_SET == rSet.GetItemState(SID_SWREGISTER_MODE)) { aRegisterCB.Check(((const SfxBoolItem&)rSet.Get( @@ -685,10 +680,10 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) SfxMapUnit eUnit = pPool->GetMetric( nWhich ); const SfxPoolItem* pOld = 0; - // alten linken und rechten Rand kopieren + // copy old left and right margins SvxLRSpaceItem aMargin( (const SvxLRSpaceItem&)rOldSet.Get( nWhich ) ); - // alten oberen und unteren Rand kopieren + // copy old top and bottom margins nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_ULSPACE ); SvxULSpaceItem aTopMargin( (const SvxULSpaceItem&)rOldSet.Get( nWhich ) ); @@ -704,7 +699,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) bModified |= sal_True; } - // Linken und rechten Rand setzen + // set left and right margins if ( bModified ) { pOld = GetOldItem( rSet, SID_ATTR_LRSPACE ); @@ -729,7 +724,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) bMod |= sal_True; } - // unteren oberen Rand setzen + // set top and bottom margins // if ( bMod ) { @@ -742,7 +737,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) } } - // Druckerschacht + // paper tray nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE_PAPERBIN ); sal_uInt16 nPos = aPaperTrayBox.GetSelectEntryPos(); sal_uInt16 nBin = (sal_uInt16)(sal_uLong)aPaperTrayBox.GetEntryData( nPos ); @@ -796,7 +791,6 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) } } - // sonstiges Zeug der Page nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE ); SvxPageItem aPage( (const SvxPageItem&)rOldSet.Get( nWhich ) ); bMod = aLayoutBox.GetSelectEntryPos() != aLayoutBox.GetSavedValue(); @@ -811,7 +805,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) bMod |= sal_True; } - // Einstellen der Numerierungsart der Seite + nPos = aNumberFormatBox.GetSelectEntryPos(); if ( nPos != aNumberFormatBox.GetSavedValue() ) @@ -835,7 +829,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) else rSet.Put( rOldSet.Get( nWhich ) ); - // Modispezifische Controls auswerten + // evaluate mode specific controls switch ( eMode ) { @@ -861,7 +855,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) case SVX_PAGE_MODE_PRESENTATION: { - // immer putten, damit Draw das auswerten kann + // always put so that draw can evaluate this rSet.Put( SfxBoolItem( GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE_EXT1 ), aAdaptBox.IsChecked() ) ); bModified |= sal_True; @@ -903,7 +897,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxPageDescPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, LayoutHdl_Impl) { - // innen au\sen umschalten + // switch inside outside const sal_uInt16 nPos = PosToPageUsage_Impl( aLayoutBox.GetSelectEntryPos() ); if ( nPos == SVX_PAGE_MIRROR ) @@ -931,10 +925,9 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, LayoutHdl_Impl) IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, PaperBinHdl_Impl) { if ( aPaperTrayBox.GetEntryCount() > 1 ) - // schon gef"ullt + // already filled return 0; - // Schacht-Box initialisieren String aOldName = aPaperTrayBox.GetSelectEntry(); aPaperTrayBox.SetUpdateMode( sal_False ); aPaperTrayBox.Clear(); @@ -987,7 +980,6 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxPageDescPage, PaperSizeSelect_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) SetMetricValue( aPaperHeightEdit, aSize.Height(), SFX_MAPUNIT_100TH_MM ); SetMetricValue( aPaperWidthEdit, aSize.Width(), SFX_MAPUNIT_100TH_MM ); - // R"ander ggf. neu berechnen CalcMargin_Impl(); RangeHdl_Impl( 0 ); @@ -995,15 +987,14 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxPageDescPage, PaperSizeSelect_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) if ( eMode == SVX_PAGE_MODE_PRESENTATION ) { - // Draw: bei Papierformat soll der Rand 1cm betragen + // Draw: if paper format the margin shall be 1 cm long nTmp = 0; sal_Bool bScreen = ( PAPER_SCREEN == ePaper ); if ( !bScreen ) - // bei Bildschirm keinen Rand - nTmp = 1; // entspr. 1cm + // no margin if screen + nTmp = 1; // accordingly 1 cm - // Abfragen, ob fuer Raender 0 gesetzt ist: if ( bScreen || aRightMarginEdit.GetValue() == 0 ) { SetMetricValue( aRightMarginEdit, nTmp, SFX_MAPUNIT_CM ); @@ -1105,13 +1096,13 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::SwapFirstValues_Impl( bool bSet ) pImpl->mpDefPrinter->SetOrientation( eOri ); pImpl->mpDefPrinter->SetMapMode( MAP_TWIP ); - // First- und Last-Werte f"ur die R"ander setzen + // set first- and last-values for margins Size aPaperSize = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetPaperSize(); Size aPrintSize = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetOutputSize(); /* - * einen Punkt ( 0,0 ) in logische Koordinaten zu konvertieren, - * sieht aus wie Unsinn; ist aber sinnvoll, wenn der Ursprung des - * Koordinatensystems verschoben ist. + * To convert a point ( 0,0 ) into logic coordinates + * looks like nonsense; but it makes sense if the + * coordinate system's origin has been moved. */ Point aPrintOffset = pImpl->mpDefPrinter->GetPageOffset() - pImpl->mpDefPrinter->PixelToLogic( Point() ); @@ -1146,7 +1137,6 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::SwapFirstValues_Impl( bool bSet ) if ( bSet ) { - // ggf. auch die Werte umsetzen, if ( nSetL < nNewL ) aLeftMarginEdit.SetValue( aLeftMarginEdit.Normalize( nNewL ), FUNIT_TWIP ); @@ -1183,7 +1173,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::UpdateExample_Impl( bool bResetbackground ) aBspWin.SetSize( aSize ); - // R"ander + // Margins aBspWin.SetTop( GetCoreValue( aTopMarginEdit, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ) ); aBspWin.SetBottom( GetCoreValue( aBottomMarginEdit, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ) ); aBspWin.SetLeft( GetCoreValue( aLeftMarginEdit, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ) ); @@ -1296,7 +1286,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::InitHeadFoot_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) const SvxSetItem* pSetItem = 0; - // Kopfzeilen-Attribute auswerten + // evaluate header attributes if ( SFX_ITEM_SET == rSet.GetItemState( GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE_HEADERSET ), @@ -1324,7 +1314,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::InitHeadFoot_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) else aBspWin.SetHeader( sal_False ); - // im Beispiel Hintergrund und Umrandung anzeigen + // show background and border in the example sal_uInt16 nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_BRUSH ); if ( rHeaderSet.GetItemState( nWhich ) >= SFX_ITEM_AVAILABLE ) @@ -1343,7 +1333,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::InitHeadFoot_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) } } - // Fusszeilen-Attribute auswerten + // evaluate footer attributes if ( SFX_ITEM_SET == rSet.GetItemState( GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE_FOOTERSET ), @@ -1371,7 +1361,7 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::InitHeadFoot_Impl( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) else aBspWin.SetFooter( sal_False ); - // im Beispiel Hintergrund und Umrandung anzeigen + // show background and border in the example sal_uInt16 nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_BRUSH ); if ( rFooterSet.GetItemState( nWhich ) >= SFX_ITEM_AVAILABLE ) @@ -1404,9 +1394,9 @@ void SvxPageDescPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) int SvxPageDescPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) { - // Abfrage, ob die Seitenr"ander ausserhalb des Druckbereichs liegen - // Wenn nicht, dann den Anwender fragen, ob sie "ubernommen werden sollen. - // Wenn nicht, dann auf der TabPage bleiben. + // Inquiry whether the page margins are beyond the printing area. + // If not, ask user whether they shall be taken. + // If not, stay on the TabPage. sal_uInt16 nPos = aPaperSizeBox.GetSelectEntryPos(); Paper ePaper = (Paper)(sal_uLong)aPaperSizeBox.GetEntryData( nPos ); @@ -1439,13 +1429,13 @@ int SvxPageDescPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) { FillItemSet( *_pSet ); - // ggf. hoch/quer putten + // put portray/landscape if applicable sal_uInt16 nWh = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PAGE_SIZE ); SfxMapUnit eUnit = GetItemSet().GetPool()->GetMetric( nWh ); Size aSize( GetCoreValue( aPaperWidthEdit, eUnit ), GetCoreValue( aPaperHeightEdit, eUnit ) ); - // putten, wenn aktuelle Gr"o/se unterschiedlich zum Wert in _pSet + // put, if current size is different to the value in _pSet const SvxSizeItem* pSize = (const SvxSizeItem*)GetItem( *_pSet, SID_ATTR_PAGE_SIZE ); if ( aSize.Width() && ( !pSize || !IsEqualSize_Impl( pSize, aSize ) ) ) _pSet->Put( SvxSizeItem( nWh, aSize ) ); @@ -1458,25 +1448,23 @@ int SvxPageDescPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, RangeHdl_Impl) { - // Aktuelle Header-Breite/H"ohe aus dem Bsp + // example window long nHHeight = aBspWin.GetHdHeight(); long nHDist = aBspWin.GetHdDist(); - // Aktuelle Footer-Breite/H"ohe aus dem Bsp long nFHeight = aBspWin.GetFtHeight(); long nFDist = aBspWin.GetFtDist(); - // Aktuelle Header/Footer-R"ander aus dem Bsp long nHFLeft = Max( aBspWin.GetHdLeft(), aBspWin.GetFtLeft() ); long nHFRight = Max( aBspWin.GetHdRight(), aBspWin.GetFtRight() ); - // Aktuelle Werte der Seitenr"ander + // current values for page margins long nBT = static_cast(aTopMarginEdit.Denormalize(aTopMarginEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); long nBB = static_cast(aBottomMarginEdit.Denormalize(aBottomMarginEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); long nBL = static_cast(aLeftMarginEdit.Denormalize(aLeftMarginEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); long nBR = static_cast(aRightMarginEdit.Denormalize(aRightMarginEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); - // Breite Umrandung der Seite berechnen + // calculate width of page border const SfxItemSet* _pSet = &GetItemSet(); Size aBorder; @@ -1493,8 +1481,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, RangeHdl_Impl) long nH = static_cast(aPaperHeightEdit.Denormalize(aPaperHeightEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); long nW = static_cast(aPaperWidthEdit.Denormalize(aPaperWidthEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); - // Grenzen Papier - // Maximum liegt bei 54cm + // limits paper + // maximum is 54 cm // long nMin = nHHeight + nHDist + nFDist + nFHeight + nBT + nBB + MINBODY + aBorder.Height(); @@ -1503,7 +1491,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, RangeHdl_Impl) nMin = MINBODY + nBL + nBR + aBorder.Width(); aPaperWidthEdit.SetMin(aPaperWidthEdit.Normalize(nMin), FUNIT_TWIP); - // Falls sich die Papiergr"o\se ge"adert hat + // if the paper size has been changed nH = static_cast(aPaperHeightEdit.Denormalize(aPaperHeightEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); nW = static_cast(aPaperWidthEdit.Denormalize(aPaperWidthEdit.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); @@ -1533,7 +1521,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPageDescPage, RangeHdl_Impl) void SvxPageDescPage::CalcMargin_Impl() { - // Aktuelle Werte der Seitenr"ander + // current values for page margins long nBT = GetCoreValue( aTopMarginEdit, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ); long nBB = GetCoreValue( aBottomMarginEdit, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/paragrph.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/paragrph.cxx index 24ebdeb8f464..27483b9b2615 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/paragrph.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/paragrph.cxx @@ -93,9 +93,9 @@ static sal_uInt16 pExtRanges[] = // define ---------------------------------------------------------------- -#define MAX_DURCH 5670 // 10 cm ist sinnvoll als maximaler Durchschuss - // laut BP -#define FIX_DIST_DEF 283 // Standard-Fix-Abstand 0,5cm +#define MAX_DURCH 5670 // 10 cm makes sense as maximum interline lead + // according to BP +#define FIX_DIST_DEF 283 // standard fix distance 0,5 cm // enum ------------------------------------------------------------------ @@ -111,7 +111,7 @@ enum LineSpaceList LLINESPACE_END }; -// C-Funktion ------------------------------------------------------------ +// C-Function ------------------------------------------------------------ void SetLineSpace_Impl( SvxLineSpacingItem&, int, long lValue = 0 ); @@ -187,19 +187,18 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxStdParagraphTabPage, ELRLoseFocusHdl) sal_Int64 nR = aRightIndent.Denormalize( aRightIndent.GetValue( eUnit ) ); String aTmp = aFLineIndent.GetText(); - // Erstzeilen Einzug if( aLeftIndent.GetMin() < 0 ) aFLineIndent.SetMin( -99999, FUNIT_MM ); else aFLineIndent.SetMin( aFLineIndent.Normalize( -nL ), eUnit ); - // Check nur fuer konkrete Breite (Shell) + // Check only for concrete width (Shell) sal_Int64 nTmp = nWidth - nL - nR - MM50; aFLineIndent.SetMax( aFLineIndent.Normalize( nTmp ), eUnit ); if ( !aTmp.Len() ) aFLineIndent.SetEmptyFieldValue(); - // Maximum Links Rechts + // maximum left right aTmp = aLeftIndent.GetText(); nTmp = nWidth - nR - MM50; aLeftIndent.SetMax( aLeftIndent.Normalize( nTmp ), eUnit ); @@ -389,7 +388,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxStdParagraphTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rOutSet ) if ( MAP_100TH_MM != eUnit ) { - // negativer Erstzeileneinzug -> ggf. Null Default-Tabstop setzen + // negative first line indent -> set null default tabstob if applicable sal_uInt16 _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_TABSTOP ); const SfxItemSet& rInSet = GetItemSet(); @@ -434,7 +433,7 @@ void SvxStdParagraphTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool?" ); String aEmpty; - // Metrik einstellen + // adjust metric FieldUnit eFUnit = GetModuleFieldUnit( rSet ); bool bApplyCharUnit = GetApplyCharUnit( rSet ); @@ -605,11 +604,11 @@ void SvxStdParagraphTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aRegisterCB.Hide(); aRegisterFL.Hide(); aAutoCB.Hide(); - if(!(nHtmlMode & HTMLMODE_SOME_STYLES)) // IE oder SW + if(!(nHtmlMode & HTMLMODE_SOME_STYLES)) // IE or SW { aRightLabel.Disable(); aRightIndent.Disable(); - aTopDist.Disable(); //HTML3.2 und NS 3.0 + aTopDist.Disable(); //HTML3.2 and NS 3.0 aBottomDist.Disable(); aFLineIndent.Disable(); aFLineLabel.Disable(); @@ -688,13 +687,13 @@ SvxStdParagraphTabPage::SvxStdParagraphTabPage( Window* pParent, bNegativeIndents(sal_False) { - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); aLineDistAtMetricBox.Hide(); FreeResource(); Init_Impl(); - aFLineIndent.SetMin(-9999); // wird default auf 0 gesetzt + aFLineIndent.SetMin(-9999); // is set to 0 on default aExampleWin.SetAccessibleName(String(CUI_RES(STR_EXAMPLE))); @@ -736,31 +735,31 @@ void SvxStdParagraphTabPage::SetLineSpacing_Impl switch( eInter ) { - // Default einzeilig + // Default single line spacing case SVX_INTER_LINE_SPACE_OFF: aLineDist.SelectEntryPos( LLINESPACE_1 ); break; - // Default einzeilig + // Default single line spacing case SVX_INTER_LINE_SPACE_PROP: if ( 100 == rAttr.GetPropLineSpace() ) { aLineDist.SelectEntryPos( LLINESPACE_1 ); break; } - // 1.5zeilig + // 1.5 line spacing if ( 150 == rAttr.GetPropLineSpace() ) { aLineDist.SelectEntryPos( LLINESPACE_15 ); break; } - // 2zeilig + // double line spacing if ( 200 == rAttr.GetPropLineSpace() ) { aLineDist.SelectEntryPos( LLINESPACE_2 ); break; } - // eingestellter Prozentwert + // the set per cent value aLineDistAtPercentBox. SetValue( aLineDistAtPercentBox.Normalize( rAttr.GetPropLineSpace() ) ); @@ -805,8 +804,8 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxStdParagraphTabPage, LineDistHdl_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) break; case LLINESPACE_DURCH: - // Setzen eines sinnvollen Defaults? - // MS Begrenzen min(10, aPageSize) + // setting a sensible default? + // limit MS min(10, aPageSize) aLineDistAtPercentBox.Hide(); pActLineDistFld = &aLineDistAtMetricBox; aLineDistAtMetricBox.SetMin(0); @@ -854,11 +853,11 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxStdParagraphTabPage, LineDistHdl_Impl, ListBox *, pBox ) sal_Int64 nTemp = aLineDistAtMetricBox.GetValue(); aLineDistAtMetricBox.SetMin(aLineDistAtMetricBox.Normalize(nMinFixDist), FUNIT_TWIP); - // wurde der Wert beim SetMin veraendert, dann ist es Zeit - // fuer den default + // if the value has been changed at SetMin, + // it is time for the default if ( aLineDistAtMetricBox.GetValue() != nTemp ) SetMetricValue( aLineDistAtMetricBox, - FIX_DIST_DEF, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ); // fix gibt's nur im Writer + FIX_DIST_DEF, SFX_MAPUNIT_TWIP ); // fix is only in Writer aLineDistAtPercentBox.Hide(); pActLineDistFld->Show(); pActLineDistFld->Enable(); @@ -1237,7 +1236,7 @@ void SvxParaAlignTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { const SvxAdjustItem& rAdj = (const SvxAdjustItem&)rSet.Get( _nWhich ); - switch ( rAdj.GetAdjust() /*!!! VB fragen rAdj.GetLastBlock()*/ ) + switch ( rAdj.GetAdjust() /*!!! ask VB rAdj.GetLastBlock()*/ ) { case SVX_ADJUST_LEFT: aLeft.Check(); break; @@ -1382,7 +1381,6 @@ void SvxParaAlignTabPage::UpdateExample_Impl( sal_Bool bAll ) aExampleWin.Draw( bAll ); } -// Erweiterungen fuer den Blocksatz einschalten void SvxParaAlignTabPage::EnableJustifyExt() { aLastLineFT.Show(); @@ -1456,7 +1454,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxExtParagraphTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rOutSet ) } } - // Seitenumbruch + // pagebreak TriState eState = aApplyCollBtn.GetState(); bool bIsPageModel = false; @@ -1490,7 +1488,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxExtParagraphTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rOutSet ) _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PARA_PAGEBREAK ); if ( bIsPageModel ) - // wird PageModel eingeschaltet, dann immer PageBreak ausschalten + // if PageModel is turned on, always turn off PageBreak rOutSet.Put( SvxFmtBreakItem( SVX_BREAK_NONE, _nWhich ) ); else { @@ -1546,7 +1544,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxExtParagraphTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rOutSet ) } - // Absatztrennung + // paragraph split _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PARA_SPLIT ); eState = aKeepTogetherBox.GetState(); @@ -1562,7 +1560,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxExtParagraphTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rOutSet ) } } - // Absaetze zusammenhalten + // keep paragraphs _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PARA_KEEP ); eState = aKeepParaBox.GetState(); @@ -1570,12 +1568,12 @@ sal_Bool SvxExtParagraphTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rOutSet ) { pOld = GetOldItem( rOutSet, SID_ATTR_PARA_KEEP ); - // hat sich der Status geaendert, muss immer geputtet werden + // if the status has changed, putting is necessary rOutSet.Put( SvxFmtKeepItem( eState == STATE_CHECK, _nWhich ) ); bModified = sal_True; } - // Witwen und Waisen + // widows and orphans _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PARA_WIDOWS ); eState = aWidowBox.GetState(); @@ -1660,7 +1658,7 @@ void SvxExtParagraphTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) if ( bPageBreak ) { - // zuerst PageModel behandeln + // first handle PageModel _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PARA_MODEL ); sal_Bool bIsPageModel = sal_False; eItemState = rSet.GetItemState( _nWhich ); @@ -1726,8 +1724,8 @@ void SvxExtParagraphTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) SvxBreak eBreak = (SvxBreak)rPageBreak.GetValue(); - // PageBreak nicht ueber CTRL-RETURN, - // dann kann CheckBox frei gegeben werden + // PageBreak not via CTRL-RETURN, + // then CheckBox can be freed aPageBreakBox.Enable(); aPageBreakBox.EnableTriState( sal_False ); aBreakTypeFT.Enable(); @@ -1821,7 +1819,7 @@ void SvxExtParagraphTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { aKeepTogetherBox.SetState( STATE_NOCHECK ); - // Witwen und Waisen + // widows and orphans aWidowBox.Enable(); _nWhich = GetWhich( SID_ATTR_PARA_WIDOWS ); SfxItemState eTmpState = rSet.GetItemState( _nWhich ); @@ -1874,7 +1872,7 @@ void SvxExtParagraphTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) else aKeepTogetherBox.Enable(sal_False); - // damit alles richt enabled wird + // so that everything is enabled correctly KeepTogetherHdl_Impl( 0 ); WidowHdl_Impl( 0 ); OrphanHdl_Impl( 0 ); @@ -1962,7 +1960,7 @@ SvxExtParagraphTabPage::SvxExtParagraphTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSe aOrphanRowNo.SetAccessibleRelationLabeledBy(&aOrphanBox); aWidowRowNo.SetAccessibleRelationLabeledBy(&aWidowBox); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); aHyphenBox.SetClickHdl( LINK( this, SvxExtParagraphTabPage, HyphenClickHdl_Impl ) ); @@ -2096,7 +2094,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxExtParagraphTabPage, WidowHdl_Impl) if ( aOrphanBox.GetState() == STATE_NOCHECK ) aKeepTogetherBox.Enable(); - // kein break + // no break case STATE_DONTKNOW: aWidowRowNo.Enable(sal_False); aWidowRowLabel.Enable(sal_False); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/swpossizetabpage.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/swpossizetabpage.cxx index b15a294d4499..2eb6f25af02b 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/swpossizetabpage.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/swpossizetabpage.cxx @@ -697,7 +697,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet) long nVertByPos = static_cast(m_aVertByMF.Denormalize(m_aVertByMF.GetValue(FUNIT_TWIP))); - // Altes Rechteck mit CoreUnit + // old rectangle with CoreUnit m_aRect = m_pSdrView->GetAllMarkedRect(); m_pSdrView->GetSdrPageView()->LogicToPagePos( m_aRect ); @@ -1049,7 +1049,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, RangeModifyHdl) if ( m_pHMap ) { - // Ausrichtung Horizontal + // horizontal alignment sal_uInt16 nMapPos = GetMapPos(m_pHMap, m_aHoriToLB); sal_uInt16 nAlign = GetAlignment(m_pHMap, nMapPos, m_aHoriLB, m_aHoriToLB); sal_uInt16 nRel = GetRelation(m_pHMap, m_aHoriToLB); @@ -1062,7 +1062,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, RangeModifyHdl) if ( m_pVMap ) { - // Ausrichtung Vertikal + // vertical alignment sal_uInt16 nMapPos = GetMapPos(m_pVMap, m_aVertLB); sal_uInt16 nAlign = GetAlignment(m_pVMap, nMapPos, m_aVertLB, m_aVertToLB); sal_uInt16 nRel = GetRelation(m_pVMap, m_aVertToLB); @@ -1092,7 +1092,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, RangeModifyHdl) nWidth = aVal.nWidth; nHeight = aVal.nHeight; - // Mindestbreite auch fuer Vorlage + // minimum width also for style m_aHeightMF.SetMin(m_aHeightMF.Normalize(aVal.nMinHeight), FUNIT_TWIP); m_aWidthMF. SetMin(m_aWidthMF.Normalize(aVal.nMinWidth), FUNIT_TWIP); @@ -1158,7 +1158,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, RelHdl, ListBox *, pLB ) else m_bAtVertPosModified = sal_True; - if(m_bHtmlMode && TextContentAnchorType_AT_CHARACTER == GetAnchorType()) // wieder Sonderbehandlung + if(m_bHtmlMode && TextContentAnchorType_AT_CHARACTER == GetAnchorType()) // again special treatment { if(bHori) { @@ -1173,7 +1173,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, RelHdl, ListBox *, pLB ) } } } - if (pLB) // Nur wenn Handler durch Aenderung des Controllers gerufen wurde + if (pLB) // only if the hanlder has been called by a change of the controller RangeModifyHdl(0); return 0; @@ -1204,7 +1204,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, PosHdl, ListBox *, pLB ) m_aVertByFT.Enable( bEnable ); } - if (pLB) // Nur wenn Handler durch Aenderung des Controllers gerufen wurde + if (pLB) // only if the hanlder has been called by a change of the controller RangeModifyHdl( 0 ); short nRel = 0; @@ -1226,15 +1226,15 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxSwPosSizeTabPage, PosHdl, ListBox *, pLB ) else m_bAtVertPosModified = sal_True; - // Sonderbehandlung fuer HTML-Mode mit horz-vert-Abhaengigkeiten + // special treatment for HTML-Mode with horz-vert-dependencies if(m_bHtmlMode && m_nHtmlMode & HTMLMODE_SOME_ABS_POS && TextContentAnchorType_AT_CHARACTER == GetAnchorType()) { sal_Bool bSet = sal_False; if(bHori) { - // rechts ist nur unterhalb erlaubt - von links nur oben - // von links am Zeichen -> unterhalb + // on the right only below is allowed - from the left only at the top + // from the left at the character -> below if((HoriOrientation::LEFT == nAlign || HoriOrientation::RIGHT == nAlign) && 0 == m_aVertLB.GetSelectEntryPos()) { @@ -1474,8 +1474,8 @@ void SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::InitPos(short nAnchor, m_aHoriLB.Enable( bEnable ); m_aHoriFT.Enable( bEnable ); - // aktuelle Pos selektieren - // Horizontal + // select current Pos + // horizontal if ( nH == USHRT_MAX ) { nH = m_nOldH; @@ -1485,7 +1485,7 @@ void SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::InitPos(short nAnchor, sal_uInt16 nMapPos = FillPosLB(m_pHMap, nH, nHRel, m_aHoriLB); FillRelLB(m_pHMap, nMapPos, nH, nHRel, m_aHoriToLB, m_aHoriToFT); - // Vertikal + // vertical if ( nV == USHRT_MAX ) { nV = m_nOldV; @@ -1497,7 +1497,7 @@ void SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::InitPos(short nAnchor, // Edits init bEnable = nH == HoriOrientation::NONE && - nAnchor != TextContentAnchorType_AS_CHARACTER;//#61359# warum nicht in Formaten&& !bFormat; + nAnchor != TextContentAnchorType_AS_CHARACTER;//#61359# why not in formats&& !bFormat; if (!bEnable) { m_aHoriByMF.SetValue( 0, FUNIT_TWIP ); @@ -1678,7 +1678,7 @@ sal_uLong SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::FillRelLB(FrmMap *pMap, sal_uInt16 nMapPos, sal_u rLB.SelectEntry(sSelEntry); else { - // Warscheinlich Ankerwechsel. Daher aehnliche Relation suchen + // Probably anchor change. So look for a similar relation. switch (nRel) { case RelOrientation::FRAME: nRel = RelOrientation::PAGE_FRAME; break; @@ -1739,11 +1739,11 @@ sal_uInt16 SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::FillPosLB(FrmMap *_pMap, ? 0L : ::lcl_GetLBRelationsForRelations( _nRel ); - // Listbox fuellen + // fill listbox std::size_t nCount = ::lcl_GetFrmMapCount(_pMap); for (std::size_t i = 0; _pMap && i < nCount; ++i) { -// #61359# Warum nicht von links/von innen bzw. von oben? +// #61359# why not from the left/from inside or from the top? // if (!bFormat || (pMap[i].eStrId != SwFPos::FROMLEFT && pMap[i].eStrId != SwFPos::FROMTOP)) { SvxSwFramePosString::StringId eStrId = m_aHoriMirrorCB.IsChecked() ? _pMap[i].eMirrorStrId : _pMap[i].eStrId; @@ -1751,7 +1751,7 @@ sal_uInt16 SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::FillPosLB(FrmMap *_pMap, String sEntry(m_aFramePosString.GetString(eStrId)); if (_rLB.GetEntryPos(sEntry) == LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND) { - // bei zeichengebundenen Rahmen keine doppelten Eintraege einfuegen + // don't insert duplicate entries at character wrapped borders _rLB.InsertEntry(sEntry); } // #i22341# - add condition to handle map @@ -1785,14 +1785,14 @@ void SvxSwPosSizeTabPage::SetView( const SdrView* pSdrView ) return; } - // Setzen des Rechtecks und der Workingarea + // setting of the rectangle and the working area m_aRect = m_pSdrView->GetAllMarkedRect(); m_pSdrView->GetSdrPageView()->LogicToPagePos( m_aRect ); // get WorkArea m_aWorkArea = m_pSdrView->GetWorkArea(); - // Beruecksichtigung Ankerposition (bei Writer) + // consider anchor position (for Writer) const SdrMarkList& rMarkList = m_pSdrView->GetMarkedObjectList(); if( rMarkList.GetMarkCount() >= 1 ) { diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.cxx index 1d270e581392..7865b5b91aaf 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.cxx @@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabDialog::SavePalettes() mpBitmapList = mpDrawModel->GetBitmapList(); } - // Speichern der Tabellen, wenn sie geaendert wurden. + // save the tables when they have been changed const String aPath( SvtPathOptions().GetPalettePath() ); @@ -155,7 +155,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabDialog::SavePalettes() mpHatchingList->Save(); SvxHatchListItem aItem( mpHatchingList, SID_HATCH_LIST ); - // ToolBoxControls werden benachrichtigt: + // ToolBoxControls are informed: if ( pShell ) pShell->PutItem( aItem ); else @@ -168,7 +168,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabDialog::SavePalettes() mpBitmapList->Save(); SvxBitmapListItem aItem( mpBitmapList, SID_BITMAP_LIST ); - // ToolBoxControls werden benachrichtigt: + // ToolBoxControls are informed: if ( pShell ) pShell->PutItem( aItem ); else @@ -183,7 +183,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabDialog::SavePalettes() mpGradientList->Save(); SvxGradientListItem aItem( mpGradientList, SID_GRADIENT_LIST ); - // ToolBoxControls werden benachrichtigt: + // ToolBoxControls are informed: if ( pShell ) pShell->PutItem( aItem ); else @@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabDialog::SavePalettes() mpColorList->Save(); SvxColorListItem aItem( mpColorList, SID_COLOR_TABLE ); - // ToolBoxControls werden benachrichtigt: + // ToolBoxControls are informed: if ( pShell ) pShell->PutItem( aItem ); else @@ -213,9 +213,9 @@ short SvxAreaTabDialog::Ok() { SavePalettes(); - // Es wird RET_OK zurueckgeliefert, wenn wenigstens eine - // TabPage in FillItemSet() sal_True zurueckliefert. Dieses - // geschieht z.Z. standardmaessig. + // RET_OK is returned, if at least one + // TabPage returns sal_True in FillItemSet(). + // This happens by default at the moment. return( SfxTabDialog::Ok() ); } @@ -250,7 +250,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabDialog::PageCreated( sal_uInt16 nId, SfxTabPage &rPage ) ( (SvxAreaTabPage&) rPage ).SetBmpChgd( &mnBitmapListState ); ( (SvxAreaTabPage&) rPage ).SetColorChgd( &mnColorListState ); ( (SvxAreaTabPage&) rPage ).Construct(); - // ActivatePage() wird das erste mal nicht gerufen + // ActivatePage() is not called the first time ( (SvxAreaTabPage&) rPage ).ActivatePage( mrOutAttrs ); break; diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.hrc b/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.hrc index 01eb1117ae5a..18f4c5680f26 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.hrc +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tabarea.hrc @@ -109,8 +109,8 @@ #define FL_OFFSET 5 #define FL_STEPCOUNT 7 -// Farben definieren TabPage -// nur temporaer !!! +// Colors define TabPage +// only temporarily!!! // #define RID_SVXPAGE_COLOR 999 //#define GRP_COLORTABLE 1 diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/textanim.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/textanim.cxx index c4f5ca7b44bc..fda275e8d56e 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/textanim.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/textanim.cxx @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ static sal_uInt16 pRanges[] = /************************************************************************* |* -|* Konstruktor des Tab-Dialogs: Fuegt die Seiten zum Dialog hinzu +|* constructor of the tab dialog: adds pages to the dialog |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ SvxTextAnimationPage::~SvxTextAnimationPage() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Liest uebergebenen Item-Set +|* reads the passed item set |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -196,7 +196,7 @@ void SvxTextAnimationPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) { const SfxItemPool* pPool = rAttrs.GetPool(); - // Animationstyp + // animation type const SfxPoolItem* pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIKIND ); if( !pItem ) @@ -210,7 +210,7 @@ void SvxTextAnimationPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aLbEffect.SetNoSelection(); aLbEffect.SaveValue(); - // Animationsrichtung + // animation direction pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIDIRECTION ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIDIRECTION ); @@ -265,7 +265,7 @@ void SvxTextAnimationPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aTsbStopInside.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); aTsbStopInside.SaveValue(); - // Anzahl + // quantity pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_ANICOUNT ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_ANICOUNT ); @@ -298,7 +298,7 @@ void SvxTextAnimationPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aTsbEndless.SaveValue(); aNumFldCount.SaveValue(); - // Verzoegerung + // delay pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIDELAY ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIDELAY ); @@ -323,7 +323,7 @@ void SvxTextAnimationPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aTsbAuto.SaveValue(); aMtrFldDelay.SaveValue(); - // Schrittweite + // step size pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIAMOUNT ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_ANIAMOUNT ); @@ -381,7 +381,7 @@ void SvxTextAnimationPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Fuellt uebergebenen Item-Set mit Dialogbox-Attributen +|* fills the passed item set with dialog box attributes |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -391,7 +391,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAnimationPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) sal_uInt16 nPos; TriState eState; - // Animationstyp + // animation type nPos = aLbEffect.GetSelectEntryPos(); if( nPos != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND && nPos != aLbEffect.GetSavedValue() ) @@ -400,7 +400,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAnimationPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) bModified = sal_True; } - // Animationsrichtung + // animation direction if( aBtnUp.GetSavedValue() != aBtnUp.IsChecked() || aBtnLeft.GetSavedValue() != aBtnLeft.IsChecked() || aBtnRight.GetSavedValue() != aBtnRight.IsChecked() || @@ -427,7 +427,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAnimationPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) bModified = sal_True; } - // Anzahl + // quantity eState = aTsbEndless.GetState(); String aStr = aNumFldCount.GetText(); if( eState != aTsbEndless.GetSavedValue() || @@ -448,7 +448,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAnimationPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) rAttrs.Put( SdrTextAniCountItem( (sal_uInt16) nValue ) ); } - // Verzoegerung + // delay eState = aTsbAuto.GetState(); aStr = aMtrFldDelay.GetText(); if( eState != aTsbAuto.GetSavedValue() || @@ -469,7 +469,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAnimationPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) rAttrs.Put( SdrTextAniDelayItem( (sal_uInt16) nValue ) ); } - // Schrittweite + // step size eState = aTsbPixel.GetState(); aStr = aMtrFldAmount.GetText(); if( eState != aTsbPixel.GetSavedValue() || @@ -516,7 +516,7 @@ sal_uInt16* SvxTextAnimationPage::GetRanges() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Erzeugt die Seite +|* creates the page |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/textattr.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/textattr.cxx index 75cc28c4a4eb..d62d7752ee3f 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/textattr.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/textattr.cxx @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ static sal_uInt16 pRanges[] = /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog (Seite) zum Kopieren von Objekten +|* dialog (page) for copying objects |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ SvxTextAttrPage::~SvxTextAttrPage() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Liest uebergebenen Item-Set +|* reads the passed item set |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -139,7 +139,6 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool" ); SfxMapUnit eUnit = pPool->GetMetric( SDRATTR_TEXT_LEFTDIST ); - // Linker Abstand vom Rahmen const SfxPoolItem* pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_LEFTDIST ); if( !pItem ) @@ -153,7 +152,6 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aMtrFldLeft.SetText( String() ); aMtrFldLeft.SaveValue(); - // Rechter Abstand vom Rahmen pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_RIGHTDIST ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_RIGHTDIST ); @@ -166,7 +164,6 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aMtrFldRight.SetText( String() ); aMtrFldRight.SaveValue(); - // Oberer Abstand vom Rahmen pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_UPPERDIST ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_UPPERDIST ); @@ -179,7 +176,6 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aMtrFldTop.SetText( String() ); aMtrFldTop.SaveValue(); - // Unterer Abstand vom Rahmen pItem = GetItem( rAttrs, SDRATTR_TEXT_LOWERDIST ); if( !pItem ) pItem = &pPool->GetDefaultItem( SDRATTR_TEXT_LOWERDIST ); @@ -192,7 +188,7 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aMtrFldBottom.SetText( String() ); aMtrFldBottom.SaveValue(); - // An Hoehe anpassen + // adjust to height if ( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_TEXT_AUTOGROWHEIGHT ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { aTsbAutoGrowHeight.SetState( ( ( const SdrTextAutoGrowHeightItem& )rAttrs.Get( SDRATTR_TEXT_AUTOGROWHEIGHT ) ). @@ -203,7 +199,7 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aTsbAutoGrowHeight.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); aTsbAutoGrowHeight.SaveValue(); - // An Breite anpassen + // adjust to width if ( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_TEXT_AUTOGROWWIDTH ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { aTsbAutoGrowWidth.SetState( ( ( const SdrTextAutoGrowWidthItem& )rAttrs.Get( SDRATTR_TEXT_AUTOGROWWIDTH ) ). @@ -317,7 +313,7 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aFlPosition.Enable( sal_False ); } - // Am Rahmen anpassen + // adjust to border if ( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_TEXT_FITTOSIZE ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { SdrFitToSizeType eFTS = (SdrFitToSizeType) @@ -329,7 +325,6 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aTsbFitToSize.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); aTsbFitToSize.SaveValue(); - // Konturfluss if( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_TEXT_CONTOURFRAME ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { sal_Bool bContour = ( ( const SdrTextContourFrameItem& )rAttrs.Get( SDRATTR_TEXT_CONTOURFRAME ) ).GetValue(); @@ -345,7 +340,7 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Fuellt uebergebenen Item-Set mit Dialogbox-Attributen +|* fills the passed item set with dialog box attributes |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -406,7 +401,6 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAttrPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) rAttrs.Put( SdrTextWordWrapItem( (sal_Bool) STATE_CHECK == eState ) ); } - // Konturfluss eState = aTsbContour.GetState(); if( eState != aTsbContour.GetSavedValue() ) { @@ -427,7 +421,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxTextAttrPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs) rAttrs.Put( SdrTextFitToSizeTypeItem( eFTS ) ); } - // zentriert + // centered RECT_POINT eRP = aCtlPosition.GetActualRP(); SdrTextVertAdjust eTVA, eOldTVA; SdrTextHorzAdjust eTHA, eOldTHA; @@ -521,10 +515,10 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Construct() { if ( ((SdrTextObj*)pObj)->HasText() ) { - // Konturfluss ist NICHT bei reinen Textobjekten m�glich + // contour NOT possible for pure text objects bContourEnabled = sal_False; - // Breite und Hoehe anpassen ist NUR bei reinen Textobjekten m�glich + // adjusting width and height is ONLY possible for pure text objects bAutoGrowWidthEnabled = bAutoGrowHeightEnabled = sal_True; } } @@ -550,7 +544,7 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::Construct() /************************************************************************* |* -|* Erzeugt die Seite +|* creates the page |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -616,7 +610,7 @@ void SvxTextAttrPage::PointChanged( Window*, RECT_POINT eRP ) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Aendert evtl. die Position des Positions-Controls +|* possibly changes the position of the position-control |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -678,7 +672,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxTextAttrPage, ClickFullWidthHdl_Impl) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Enabled/Disabled "Groesse an Text" oder "Am Rahmen Anpassen" +|* enables/disables "size at text" or "adjust to frame" |* \************************************************************************/ diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tparea.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tparea.cxx index 214496a2d045..e29dd2c36fc8 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tparea.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tparea.cxx @@ -504,7 +504,7 @@ void SvxTransparenceTabPage::ActivatePage(const SfxItemSet& rSet) if (pPageTypeItem) SetPageType(pPageTypeItem->GetValue()); - if(nDlgType == 0) // Flaechen-Dialog + if(nDlgType == 0) // area dialog nPageType = PT_TRANSPARENCE; InitPreview ( rSet ); @@ -669,7 +669,7 @@ SvxAreaTabPage::SvxAreaTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs ) : aCtlXRectPreview.SetAccessibleName(accName); aCtlBitmapPreview.SetAccessibleName(accName); - // Gruppen, die sich ueberlagern + // groups that overlay each other aLbBitmap.Hide(); aCtlBitmapPreview.Hide(); @@ -726,7 +726,7 @@ SvxAreaTabPage::SvxAreaTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs ) : DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool?" ); ePoolUnit = pPool->GetMetric( XATTR_FILLBMP_SIZEX ); - // Setzen Output-Devices + // setting the output device rXFSet.Put( XFillStyleItem( XFILL_SOLID ) ); rXFSet.Put( XFillColorItem( String(), COL_BLACK ) ); aCtlXRectPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -800,14 +800,14 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) SetPageType(pPageTypeItem->GetValue()); if (pPosItem) SetPos(pPosItem->GetValue()); - if( nDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( nDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { *pbAreaTP = sal_True; if( pColorList.is() ) { sal_uInt16 _nPos = 0; - // Bitmapliste + if( *pnBitmapListState ) { if( *pnBitmapListState & CT_CHANGED ) @@ -827,7 +827,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aLbBitmap.SelectEntryPos( _nPos ); ModifyBitmapHdl_Impl( this ); } - // hatch-liste + if( *pnHatchingListState ) { if( *pnHatchingListState & CT_CHANGED ) @@ -849,7 +849,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) ModifyHatchBckgrdColorHdl_Impl( this ); } - // gradient-liste + if( *pnGradientListState ) { if( *pnGradientListState & CT_CHANGED ) @@ -869,7 +869,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aLbGradient.SelectEntryPos( _nPos ); ModifyGradientHdl_Impl( this ); } - // ColorList + if( *pnColorListState ) { if( *pnColorListState & CT_CHANGED ) @@ -944,7 +944,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) int SvxAreaTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) { - if( nDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( nDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { sal_uInt16 nPosOrig = nPos; XFillStyle eStyle = (XFillStyle) aTypeLB.GetSelectEntryPos(); @@ -1035,7 +1035,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) bModified = sal_True; } } - // NEU + // NEW if( (eSavedStyle != eStyle) && ( bModified || SFX_ITEM_SET == rOutAttrs.GetItemState( GetWhich( XATTR_FILLCOLOR ), sal_True ) ) ) @@ -1066,7 +1066,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) bModified = sal_True; } } - // NEU + // NEW if( (eSavedStyle != eStyle) && ( bModified || SFX_ITEM_SET == rOutAttrs.GetItemState( GetWhich( XATTR_FILLGRADIENT ), sal_True ) ) ) @@ -1112,7 +1112,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) bModified = sal_True; } } - // NEU + // NEW if( (eSavedStyle != eStyle) && ( bModified || SFX_ITEM_SET == rOutAttrs.GetItemState( GetWhich( XATTR_FILLHATCH ), sal_True ) ) ) @@ -1143,7 +1143,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) bModified = sal_True; } } - // NEU + // NEW if( (eSavedStyle != eStyle) && ( bModified || SFX_ITEM_SET == rOutAttrs.GetItemState( GetWhich( XATTR_FILLBITMAP ), sal_True ) ) ) @@ -1160,7 +1160,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) break; } - // Schrittweite + // step size if( aTsbStepCount.IsEnabled() ) { sal_uInt16 nValue = 0; @@ -1173,7 +1173,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } else { - // Zustand != Disabled ? + // condition != Disabled ? if( aNumFldStepCount.GetText().Len() > 0 ) { nValue = (sal_uInt16) aNumFldStepCount.GetValue(); @@ -1193,7 +1193,6 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } } - // Kacheln if( aTsbTile.IsEnabled() ) { TriState eState = aTsbTile.GetState(); @@ -1209,7 +1208,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } } } - // Stretchen + if( aTsbStretch.IsEnabled() ) { TriState eState = aTsbStretch.GetState(); @@ -1226,8 +1225,8 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } } - // Originalgroesse (im UI) wird wie folgt benutzt: - // Controls sind disabled, muessen aber gesetzt werden. + // Original size (in the UI) is used as follows: + // Controls are disabled, but have to be set. // SizeX = 0; SizeY = 0; Log = sal_True //aTsbScale @@ -1269,9 +1268,8 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) pItem = new XFillBmpSizeXItem( GetCoreValue( aMtrFldXSize, ePoolUnit ) ); else { - // Prozentwerte werden negativ gesetzt, damit - // diese nicht skaliert werden; dieses wird - // im Item beruecksichtigt + // Percentage values are set negatively, so that + // they aren't scaled; this is considered in the item. pItem = new XFillBmpSizeXItem( -labs( static_cast(aMtrFldXSize.GetValue()) ) ); } } @@ -1306,9 +1304,9 @@ sal_Bool SvxAreaTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) pItem = new XFillBmpSizeYItem( GetCoreValue( aMtrFldYSize, ePoolUnit ) ); else { - // Prozentwerte werden negativ gesetzt, damit - // diese vom MetricItem nicht skaliert werden; - // dieses wird im Item beruecksichtigt + // Percentage values are set negatively, so that + // they aren't scaled by the MetricItem; + // this is considered in the item. pItem = new XFillBmpSizeYItem( -labs( static_cast(aMtrFldYSize.GetValue()) ) ); } } @@ -1516,7 +1514,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } else { - // Alle LBs nicht zug"anglich machen + // make all LBs not accessible aLbColor.Hide(); aLbGradient.Hide(); aLbHatching.Hide(); @@ -1525,11 +1523,11 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aLbColor.Disable(); aLbColor.Show(); - // Damit Reset() auch mit Zurueck richtig funktioniert + // so that Reset() also works correctly with Back aTypeLB.SetNoSelection(); } - // Schrittweite + // step size if( ( rAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_GRADIENTSTEPCOUNT ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) || ( rAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_FILLSTYLE ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) ) { @@ -1553,9 +1551,8 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aNumFldStepCount.SetText( String() ); } - // Attribute fuer die Bitmap-Fuellung + // attributes for the bitmap filling - // Ist Kacheln gesetzt? if( rAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_FILLBMP_TILE ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { aTsbTile.EnableTriState( sal_False ); @@ -1568,7 +1565,6 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) else aTsbTile.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); - // Ist Stretchen gesetzt? if( rAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_FILLBMP_STRETCH ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { aTsbStretch.EnableTriState( sal_False ); @@ -1598,7 +1594,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) aTsbScale.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); - // Status fuer Originalgroesse ermitteln + // determine status for the original size TriState eOriginal = STATE_NOCHECK; //aMtrFldXSize @@ -1607,8 +1603,8 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) sal_Int32 nValue = ( ( const XFillBmpSizeXItem& ) rAttrs.Get( XATTR_FILLBMP_SIZEX ) ).GetValue(); if( aTsbScale.GetState() == STATE_CHECK ) { - // Wenn im Item eine Prozentangabe steckt, - // so ist diese wegen des MetricItems negativ + // If there's a percentage value in the item, + // it is negative because of the MetricItems. aMtrFldXSize.SetValue( labs( nValue ) ); } else @@ -1618,8 +1614,8 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) if( nValue == 0 ) { eOriginal = STATE_CHECK; - // Wert ist beim Ausschalten von Originalgroesse sonst zu klein - // (Performance-Problem) + // value would be too small otherwise when turning off the original size + // (performance problem) aMtrFldXSize.SetValue( 100 ); } } @@ -1635,8 +1631,8 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) sal_Int32 nValue = ( ( const XFillBmpSizeYItem& ) rAttrs.Get( XATTR_FILLBMP_SIZEY ) ).GetValue(); if( aTsbScale.GetState() == STATE_CHECK ) { - // Wenn im Item eine Prozentangabe steckt, - // so ist diese wegen des MetricItems negativ + // If there's a percentage value in the item, + // it is negative because of the MetricItems. aMtrFldYSize.SetValue( labs( nValue ) ); } else @@ -1715,11 +1711,10 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) else aMtrFldYOffset.SetText( String() ); - // Erst hier, damit Tile und Stretch mit beruecksichtigt wird + // not earlier so that tile and stretch are considered if( aTypeLB.GetSelectEntryPos() == XFILL_BITMAP ) ClickBitmapHdl_Impl(); - // Werte sichern aTypeLB.SaveValue(); aLbColor.SaveValue(); aLbGradient.SaveValue(); @@ -1854,7 +1849,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ClickColorHdl_Impl() aCbxHatchBckgrd.Hide(); aLbHatchBckgrdColor.Hide(); - // Text der Tabelle setzen + // set table text String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pColorList->GetPath() ); @@ -1885,7 +1880,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyColorHdl_Impl) rXFSet.Put( XFillColorItem( String(), aLbColor.GetSelectEntryColor() ) ); } - // NEU + // NEW else if( SFX_ITEM_SET == rOutAttrs.GetItemState( GetWhich( XATTR_FILLCOLOR ), sal_True, &pPoolItem ) ) { rXFSet.Put( XFillStyleItem( XFILL_SOLID ) ); @@ -1943,7 +1938,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ClickGradientHdl_Impl() aCbxHatchBckgrd.Hide(); aLbHatchBckgrdColor.Hide(); - // Text der Tabelle setzen + // set table text String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pGradientList->GetPath() ); @@ -1970,7 +1965,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyGradientHdl_Impl) sal_uInt16 _nPos = aLbGradient.GetSelectEntryPos(); if( _nPos != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND ) { - // ItemSet fuellen und an aCtlXRectPreview weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to aCtlXRectPreview XGradientEntry* pEntry = pGradientList->GetGradient( _nPos ); rXFSet.Put( XFillStyleItem( XFILL_GRADIENT ) ); @@ -2034,7 +2029,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ClickHatchingHdl_Impl() aCbxHatchBckgrd.Enable(); aLbHatchBckgrdColor.Enable(); - // Text der Tabelle setzen + // set table text String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pHatchingList->GetPath() ); @@ -2062,7 +2057,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyHatchingHdl_Impl) sal_uInt16 _nPos = aLbHatching.GetSelectEntryPos(); if( _nPos != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND ) { - // ItemSet fuellen und an aCtlXRectPreview weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to aCtlXRectPreview XHatchEntry* pEntry = pHatchingList->GetHatch( _nPos ); rXFSet.Put( XFillStyleItem( XFILL_HATCH ) ); @@ -2193,7 +2188,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::ClickBitmapHdl_Impl() aMtrFldOffset.Show(); aFlOffset.Show(); - // Text der Tabelle setzen + // set table text String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pBitmapList->GetPath() ); @@ -2220,7 +2215,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyBitmapHdl_Impl) sal_uInt16 _nPos = aLbBitmap.GetSelectEntryPos(); if( _nPos != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND ) { - // ItemSet fuellen und an aCtlXRectPreview weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to aCtlXRectPreview XBitmapEntry* pEntry = pBitmapList->GetBitmap( _nPos ); rXFSet.Put( XFillStyleItem( XFILL_BITMAP ) ); @@ -2260,7 +2255,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyStepCountHdl_Impl, void *, p ) sal_uInt16 nValue = 0; if( aTsbStepCount.GetState() != STATE_CHECK ) { - // Zustand != Disabled ? + // condition != Disabled ? if( aNumFldStepCount.GetText().Len() > 0 ) nValue = (sal_uInt16) aNumFldStepCount.GetValue(); } @@ -2404,7 +2399,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyTileHdl_Impl) } else if( aTsbOriginal.IsEnabled() && aTsbOriginal.GetState() == STATE_CHECK ) { - // Originalgroesse -> Size == 0 + // original size -> size == 0 rXFSet.Put( XFillBmpSizeXItem( 0 ) ); rXFSet.Put( XFillBmpSizeLogItem( sal_True ) ); } @@ -2425,7 +2420,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAreaTabPage, ModifyTileHdl_Impl) } else if( aTsbOriginal.IsEnabled() && aTsbOriginal.GetState() == STATE_CHECK ) { - // Originalgroesse -> Size == 0 + // original size -> size == 0 rXFSet.Put( XFillBmpSizeYItem( 0 ) ); rXFSet.Put( XFillBmpSizeLogItem( sal_True ) ); } @@ -2504,7 +2499,7 @@ void SvxAreaTabPage::PointChanged( Window* pWindow, RECT_POINT eRcPt ) { eRP = eRcPt; - // Ausrichtung der Bitmapfuellung + // alignment of the bitmap fill ModifyTileHdl_Impl( pWindow ); } diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tpbitmap.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tpbitmap.cxx index 0786df4da713..01adb764584b 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tpbitmap.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tpbitmap.cxx @@ -106,10 +106,10 @@ SvxBitmapTabPage::SvxBitmapTabPage { FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); - // Setzen des Output-Devices + // setting the output device rXFSet.Put( aXFStyleItem ); rXFSet.Put( aXBitmapItem ); @@ -146,11 +146,9 @@ SvxBitmapTabPage::SvxBitmapTabPage void SvxBitmapTabPage::Construct() { - // Farbtabellen aLbColor.Fill( pColorList ); aLbBackgroundColor.CopyEntries( aLbColor ); - // Bitmaptabelle aLbBitmaps.Fill( pBitmapList ); } @@ -161,7 +159,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) sal_uInt16 nPos; sal_uInt16 nCount; - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { *pbAreaTP = sal_False; @@ -180,7 +178,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) aLbColor.Fill( pColorList ); nCount = aLbColor.GetEntryCount(); if( nCount == 0 ) - ; // Dieser Fall sollte nicht auftreten + ; // this case should not occur else if( nCount <= nPos ) aLbColor.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); else @@ -192,7 +190,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) aLbBackgroundColor.CopyEntries( aLbColor ); nCount = aLbBackgroundColor.GetEntryCount(); if( nCount == 0 ) - ; // Dieser Fall sollte nicht auftreten + ; // this case should not occur else if( nCount <= nPos ) aLbBackgroundColor.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); else @@ -202,8 +200,8 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) ChangeBackgrndColorHdl_Impl( this ); } - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (possibly cutting) the name and + // displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pBitmapList->GetPath() ); @@ -222,7 +220,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) { aLbBitmaps.SelectEntryPos( *pPos ); } - // Farben koennten geloescht worden sein + // colors could have been deleted ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl( this ); *pPageType = PT_BITMAP; @@ -248,11 +246,11 @@ int SvxBitmapTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet) sal_Bool SvxBitmapTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& _rOutAttrs ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 && *pbAreaTP == sal_False ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 && *pbAreaTP == sal_False ) // area dialog { if( *pPageType == PT_BITMAP ) { - // CheckChanges_Impl(); <-- doppelte Abfrage ? + // CheckChanges_Impl(); <-- duplicate inquiry? XOBitmap aXOBitmap; String aString; @@ -290,7 +288,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) aBitmapCtl.SetBackgroundColor( aLbBackgroundColor.GetSelectEntryColor() ); aBitmapCtl.SetBmpArray( aCtlPixel.GetBitmapPixelPtr() ); - // Bitmap holen und darstellen + // get bitmap and display it XFillBitmapItem aBmpItem( (const String &) String(), aBitmapCtl.GetXBitmap() ); rXFSet.Put( aBmpItem ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -298,7 +296,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl( this ); - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pBitmapList->Count() ) { aBtnAdd.Enable(); @@ -476,7 +474,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl) aBtnModify.Enable(); aBtnAdd.Enable(); - // Setzen des PixelControls + // setting the pixel control aCtlPixel.SetXBitmap( *pXOBitmap ); Color aPixelColor = pXOBitmap->GetPixelColor(); @@ -485,8 +483,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl) aBitmapCtl.SetPixelColor( aPixelColor ); aBitmapCtl.SetBackgroundColor( aBackColor ); - // Wenn der Eintrag nicht in der Listbox ist, wird die Farbe - // temporaer hinzugenommen + // if the entry is not in the listbox, + // the color is added temporarily if( 0 == aLbBitmaps.GetSelectEntryPos() ) { aLbColor.SelectEntry( Color( COL_BLACK ) ); @@ -508,7 +506,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl) } aCtlPixel.Invalidate(); - // Bitmap darstellen + // display bitmap XFillBitmapItem aXBmpItem( (const String &) String(), *pXOBitmap ); rXFSet.Put( aXBmpItem ); @@ -550,13 +548,13 @@ long SvxBitmapTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() switch( nRet ) { - case RET_BTN_1: // Aendern + case RET_BTN_1: { ClickModifyHdl_Impl( this ); } break; - case RET_BTN_2: // Hinzufuegen + case RET_BTN_2: { ClickAddHdl_Impl( this ); nPos = aLbBitmaps.GetSelectEntryPos(); @@ -649,7 +647,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) pEntry = new XBitmapEntry( aXOBitmap, aName ); } - else // Es muss sich um eine nicht vorhandene importierte Bitmap handeln + else // it must be a not existing imported bitmap { const SfxPoolItem* pPoolItem = NULL; if( SFX_ITEM_SET == rOutAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_FILLBITMAP, sal_True, &pPoolItem ) ) @@ -678,14 +676,13 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) } #endif - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnBitmapListState |= CT_MODIFIED; ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl( this ); } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pBitmapList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -785,14 +782,13 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickImportHdl_Impl) } #endif - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnBitmapListState |= CT_MODIFIED; ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl( this ); } } else - // Graphik konnte nicht geladen werden + // graphic couldn't be loaded ErrorBox( GetParentDialog(), WinBits( WB_OK ), String( ResId( RID_SVXSTR_READ_DATA_ERROR, rMgr ) ) ).Execute(); @@ -858,7 +854,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) aLbBitmaps.Modify( pEntry, nPos ); aLbBitmaps.SelectEntryPos( nPos ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnBitmapListState |= CT_MODIFIED; bBmpChanged = sal_False; @@ -897,11 +892,10 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickDeleteHdl_Impl) ChangeBitmapHdl_Impl( this ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnBitmapListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( !pBitmapList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Disable(); @@ -946,7 +940,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) aPathURL.removeSegment(); aPathURL.removeFinalSlash(); - // Tabelle speichern + // save table XBitmapListRef pBmpList = XPropertyList::CreatePropertyList( XBITMAP_LIST, aPathURL.GetMainURL( INetURLObject::NO_DECODE ), pXPool )->AsBitmapList(); pBmpList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); @@ -961,8 +955,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) pBitmapList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (possibly cutting) the name + // displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( ResId( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE, rMgr ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); @@ -974,9 +968,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) else aString += String(aURL.getBase()); - // Flag fuer gewechselt setzen *pnBitmapListState |= CT_CHANGED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnBitmapListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; LeaveWait(); } @@ -989,7 +981,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pBitmapList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -1039,8 +1031,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) if( pBitmapList->Save() ) { - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (possibly cutting) the name + // displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); @@ -1052,9 +1044,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) else aString += String(aURL.getBase()); - // Flag fuer gespeichert setzen *pnBitmapListState |= CT_SAVED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnBitmapListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -1076,7 +1066,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ChangePixelColorHdl_Impl) aBitmapCtl.SetPixelColor( aLbColor.GetSelectEntryColor() ); - // Bitmap holen und darstellen + // get bitmap and display it rXFSet.Put( XFillBitmapItem( String(), aBitmapCtl.GetXBitmap() ) ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); aCtlPreview.Invalidate(); @@ -1095,7 +1085,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxBitmapTabPage, ChangeBackgrndColorHdl_Impl) aBitmapCtl.SetBackgroundColor( aLbBackgroundColor.GetSelectEntryColor() ); - // Bitmap holen und darstellen + // get bitmap and display it rXFSet.Put( XFillBitmapItem( String(), aBitmapCtl.GetXBitmap() ) ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); aCtlPreview.Invalidate(); @@ -1113,7 +1103,7 @@ void SvxBitmapTabPage::PointChanged( Window* pWindow, RECT_POINT ) { aBitmapCtl.SetBmpArray( aCtlPixel.GetBitmapPixelPtr() ); - // Bitmap holen und darstellen + // get bitmap and display it rXFSet.Put( XFillBitmapItem( String(), aBitmapCtl.GetXBitmap() ) ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); aCtlPreview.Invalidate(); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tpcolor.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tpcolor.cxx index 7c45d0451a51..bf027bc62195 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tpcolor.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tpcolor.cxx @@ -196,7 +196,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLoadSaveEmbed, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) meType, aDlg.GetPath(), mpXPool )->AsColorList(); if( pList->Load() ) { - // Pruefen, ob Tabelle geloescht werden darf: + // check whether the table may be deleted: SvxAreaTabDialog* pArea = dynamic_cast< SvxAreaTabDialog* >( mpTopDlg ); SvxLineTabDialog* pLine = dynamic_cast< SvxLineTabDialog* >( mpTopDlg ); @@ -384,16 +384,16 @@ SvxColorTabPage::SvxColorTabPage { FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); - // Setzen des Output-Devices + // setting the output device rXFSet.Put( aXFStyleItem ); rXFSet.Put( aXFillColorItem ); aCtlPreviewOld.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); aCtlPreviewNew.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); - // Handler ueberladen + // overload handler aLbColor.SetSelectHdl( LINK( this, SvxColorTabPage, SelectColorLBHdl_Impl ) ); aValSetColorList.SetSelectHdl( @@ -447,7 +447,7 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::Construct() void SvxColorTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { *pbAreaTP = sal_False; @@ -476,7 +476,7 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) aMtrFldColorModel2.SetValue( ColorToPercent_Impl( aAktuellColor.GetGreen() ) ); aMtrFldColorModel3.SetValue( ColorToPercent_Impl( aAktuellColor.GetBlue() ) ); - // ItemSet fuellen und an XOut weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to XOut rXFSet.Put( XFillColorItem( String(), aAktuellColor ) ); aCtlPreviewOld.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); aCtlPreviewNew.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -486,7 +486,7 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) } } - // Damit evtl. geaenderte Farbe verworfen wird + // so that the possibly changed color is discarded SelectColorLBHdl_Impl( this ); *pPageType = PT_COLOR; @@ -514,7 +514,7 @@ int SvxColorTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) long SvxColorTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() { - // wird hier benutzt, um Aenderungen NICHT zu verlieren + // used to NOT lose changes Color aTmpColor (aAktuellColor); if (eCM != CM_RGB) @@ -526,7 +526,7 @@ long SvxColorTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() Color aColor = pColorList->GetColor( nPos )->GetColor(); String aString = aLbColor.GetSelectEntry(); - // aNewColor, da COL_USER != COL_irgendwas, auch wenn RGB-Werte gleich + // aNewColor, because COL_USER != COL_something, even if RGB values are the same // Color aNewColor( aColor.GetRed(), aColor.GetGreen(), aColor.GetBlue() ); if( ColorToPercent_Impl( aTmpColor.GetRed() ) != ColorToPercent_Impl( aColor.GetRed() ) || @@ -550,14 +550,14 @@ long SvxColorTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() switch( nRet ) { - case RET_BTN_1: // Aendern + case RET_BTN_1: { ClickModifyHdl_Impl( this ); aColor = pColorList->GetColor( nPos )->GetColor(); } break; - case RET_BTN_2: // Hinzufuegen + case RET_BTN_2: { ClickAddHdl_Impl( this ); nPos = aLbColor.GetSelectEntryPos(); @@ -571,7 +571,7 @@ long SvxColorTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() delete aMessDlg; } } - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { nPos = aLbColor.GetSelectEntryPos(); if( nPos != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND ) @@ -634,7 +634,7 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aEdtName.SetText( aLbColor.GetSelectEntry() ); } - // Farbmodell setzen + // set color model String aStr = GetUserData(); aLbColorModel.SelectEntryPos( (sal_uInt16) aStr.ToInt32() ); @@ -656,11 +656,11 @@ SfxTabPage* SvxColorTabPage::Create( Window* pWindow, //------------------------------------------------------------------------ // -// Wird aufgerufen, wenn Inhalt der MtrFileds f�r Farbwerte ver�ndert wird +// is called when the content of the MtrFields is changed for color values // IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ModifiedHdl_Impl) { - // lese aktuelle MtrFields aus, wenn cmyk, dann k-Wert als Trans.-Farbe + // read current MtrFields, if cmyk, then k-value as transparency aAktuellColor.SetColor ( Color( (sal_uInt8)PercentToColor_Impl( (sal_uInt16) aMtrFldColorModel4.GetValue() ), (sal_uInt8)PercentToColor_Impl( (sal_uInt16) aMtrFldColorModel1.GetValue() ), (sal_uInt8)PercentToColor_Impl( (sal_uInt16) aMtrFldColorModel2.GetValue() ), @@ -695,12 +695,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) long nCount = pColorList->Count(); sal_Bool bDifferent = sal_True; - // Pruefen, ob Name schon vorhanden ist + // check if name is already existing for ( long i = 0; i < nCount && bDifferent; i++ ) if ( aName == pColorList->GetColor( i )->GetName() ) bDifferent = sal_False; - // Wenn ja, wird wiederholt ein neuer Name angefordert + // if yes, it is repeated and a new name is demanded if ( !bDifferent ) { WarningBox aWarningBox( GetParentDialog(), WinBits( WB_OK ), @@ -731,7 +731,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) delete( pDlg ); } - // Wenn nicht vorhanden, wird Eintrag aufgenommen + // if not existing the entry is entered if( bDifferent ) { if (eCM != CM_RGB) @@ -746,7 +746,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) aLbColor.SelectEntryPos( aLbColor.GetEntryCount() - 1 ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnColorListState |= CT_MODIFIED; SelectColorLBHdl_Impl( this ); @@ -770,12 +769,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) long nCount = pColorList->Count(); sal_Bool bDifferent = sal_True; - // Pruefen, ob Name schon vorhanden ist + // check if name is already existing for ( long i = 0; i < nCount && bDifferent; i++ ) if ( aName == pColorList->GetColor( i )->GetName() && nPos != i ) bDifferent = sal_False; - // Wenn ja, wird wiederholt ein neuer Name angefordert + // if yes, it is repeated and a new name is demanded if ( !bDifferent ) { WarningBox aWarningBox( GetParentDialog(), WinBits( WB_OK ), @@ -804,7 +803,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) delete( pDlg ); } - // Wenn nicht vorhanden, wird Eintrag aufgenommen + // if not existing the entry is entered if( bDifferent ) { XColorEntry* pEntry = pColorList->GetColor( nPos ); @@ -825,7 +824,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) aCtlPreviewOld.Invalidate(); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnColorListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } } @@ -858,7 +856,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickWorkOnHdl_Impl) aMtrFldColorModel3.SetValue( ColorToPercent_Impl( aAktuellColor.GetBlue() ) ); aMtrFldColorModel4.SetValue( ColorToPercent_Impl( nK ) ); - // ItemSet fuellen und an XOut weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to XOut rXFSet.Put( XFillColorItem( String(), aPreviewColor ) ); //aCtlPreviewOld.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr ); aCtlPreviewNew.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -887,18 +885,17 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, ClickDeleteHdl_Impl) DBG_ASSERT( pEntry, "ColorEntry not found !" ); delete pEntry; - // Listbox und ValueSet aktualisieren + // update Listbox and ValueSet aLbColor.RemoveEntry( nPos ); aValSetColorList.Clear(); FillValueSet_Impl( aValSetColorList ); - // Positionieren + // positioning aLbColor.SelectEntryPos( nPos ); SelectColorLBHdl_Impl( this ); aCtlPreviewOld.Invalidate(); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnColorListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } } @@ -955,9 +952,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, SelectValSetHdl_Impl) //------------------------------------------------------------------------ -// -// Farbwerte je nach �bergebenes Farbmodell umrechnen -// void SvxColorTabPage::ConvertColorValues (Color& rColor, ColorModel eModell) { switch (eModell) @@ -979,9 +973,6 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::ConvertColorValues (Color& rColor, ColorModel eModell) } } -// -// Auswahl Listbox 'Farbmodell' (RGB/CMY) -// IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, SelectColorModelHdl_Impl) { int nPos = aLbColorModel.GetSelectEntryPos(); @@ -989,7 +980,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, SelectColorModelHdl_Impl) { if (eCM != (ColorModel) nPos) { - // wenn Farbmodell geaendert wurde, dann Werte umrechnen ConvertColorValues (aAktuellColor, (ColorModel) nPos); } @@ -1017,14 +1007,14 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, SelectColorModelHdl_Impl) aMtrFldColorModel2.SetHelpId( HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_2 ); aMtrFldColorModel3.SetHelpId( HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_3 ); - // Da der alte HelpText noch am Control steht wuerde - // ein Umsetzen der HelpID alleine nichts bewirken + // Because the old HelpText is still at the Control + // a change of the HelpID alone would not work aMtrFldColorModel1.SetHelpText( String() ); aMtrFldColorModel2.SetHelpText( String() ); aMtrFldColorModel3.SetHelpText( String() ); - // RGB-Werte im Bereich 0..255 verarbeiten (nicht in %), - // dazu MetricField's entsprechend einstellen + // handle RGB-values (0..255, not in %), + // and adjust MetricFields respectively aMtrFldColorModel1.SetUnit(FUNIT_NONE); aMtrFldColorModel1.SetMin(0); aMtrFldColorModel1.SetMax(255); @@ -1068,8 +1058,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxColorTabPage, SelectColorModelHdl_Impl) aMtrFldColorModel2.SetHelpText( String() ); aMtrFldColorModel3.SetHelpText( String() ); - // CMYK-Werte im Bereich 0..100% verarbeiten, - // dazu MetricField's entsprechend einstellen + // handle CMYK-values (0..100%) + // and adjust MetricFields respectively String aStrUnit( RTL_CONSTASCII_USTRINGPARAM( " %" ) ); aMtrFldColorModel1.SetUnit(FUNIT_CUSTOM); @@ -1125,7 +1115,7 @@ long SvxColorTabPage::ChangeColorHdl_Impl( void* ) aMtrFldColorModel3.SetValue( ColorToPercent_Impl( aAktuellColor.GetBlue() ) ); aMtrFldColorModel4.SetValue( ColorToPercent_Impl( aAktuellColor.GetTransparency() ) ); - // ItemSet fuellen und an XOut weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to XOut rXFSet.Put( XFillColorItem( String(), pEntry->GetColor() ) ); aCtlPreviewOld.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); aCtlPreviewNew.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -1154,11 +1144,10 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::FillValueSet_Impl( ValueSet& rVs ) //------------------------------------------------------------------------ -// Ein RGB-Wert wird in einen CMYK-Wert konvertiert, wobei die Color- -// Klasse vergewaltigt wird, da R in C, G in M und B in Y umgewandelt -// wird. Der Wert K wird in einer Extra-Variablen gehalten. -// Bei weiteren Farbmodellen sollte man hierfuer eigene Klassen entwickeln, -// die dann auch entsprechende Casts enthalten. +// A RGB value is converted to a CMYK value - not in an ideal way as +// R is converted into C, G into M and B into Y. The K value is held in an +// extra variable. For further color models one should develop own +// classes which should contain the respective casts. void SvxColorTabPage::RgbToCmyk_Impl( Color& rColor, sal_uInt16& rK ) { @@ -1175,7 +1164,7 @@ void SvxColorTabPage::RgbToCmyk_Impl( Color& rColor, sal_uInt16& rK ) //------------------------------------------------------------------------ -// Umgekehrter Fall zu RgbToCmyk_Impl (s.o.) +// reverse case to RgbToCmyk_Impl (see above) void SvxColorTabPage::CmykToRgb_Impl( Color& rColor, const sal_uInt16 nK ) { @@ -1244,7 +1233,7 @@ sal_uInt16 SvxColorTabPage::PercentToColor_Impl( sal_uInt16 nPercent ) void SvxColorTabPage::FillUserData() { - // Das Farbmodell wird in der Ini-Datei festgehalten + // the color model is saved in the Ini-file SetUserData( UniString::CreateFromInt32( eCM ) ); } diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tpgradnt.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tpgradnt.cxx index a974b11bcd69..39802fcccf9f 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tpgradnt.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tpgradnt.cxx @@ -98,20 +98,20 @@ SvxGradientTabPage::SvxGradientTabPage aLbGradients.SetAccessibleName( GetText()); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); - // Solange NICHT vom Item unterstuetzt + // as long as NOT supported by the item aMtrColorTo.SetValue( 100 ); aMtrColorFrom.SetValue( 100 ); - // Setzen des Output-Devices + // setting the output device rXFSet.Put( aXFStyleItem ); rXFSet.Put( aXGradientItem ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); - // Handler ueberladen + // overload the handler aLbGradients.SetSelectHdl( LINK( this, SvxGradientTabPage, ChangeGradientHdl_Impl ) ); aBtnAdd.SetClickHdl( LINK( this, SvxGradientTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl ) ); @@ -149,11 +149,9 @@ SvxGradientTabPage::SvxGradientTabPage void SvxGradientTabPage::Construct() { - // Farbtabelle aLbColorFrom.Fill( pColorList ); aLbColorTo.CopyEntries( aLbColorFrom ); - // Farbverlauftabelle aLbGradients.Fill( pGradientList ); } @@ -164,7 +162,7 @@ void SvxGradientTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) sal_uInt16 nPos; sal_uInt16 nCount; - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { *pbAreaTP = sal_False; @@ -183,7 +181,7 @@ void SvxGradientTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) aLbColorFrom.Fill( pColorList ); nCount = aLbColorFrom.GetEntryCount(); if( nCount == 0 ) - ; // Dieser Fall sollte nicht auftreten + ; // this case should not occur else if( nCount <= nPos ) aLbColorFrom.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); else @@ -195,7 +193,7 @@ void SvxGradientTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) aLbColorTo.CopyEntries( aLbColorFrom ); nCount = aLbColorTo.GetEntryCount(); if( nCount == 0 ) - ; // Dieser Fall sollte nicht auftreten + ; // this case should not occur else if( nCount <= nPos ) aLbColorTo.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); else @@ -204,8 +202,8 @@ void SvxGradientTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) ModifiedHdl_Impl( this ); } - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (and possibly cutting) the name and + // displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pGradientList->GetPath() ); @@ -224,7 +222,7 @@ void SvxGradientTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) { aLbGradients.SelectEntryPos( *pPos ); } - // Farben koennten geloescht worden sein + // colors could have been deleted ChangeGradientHdl_Impl( this ); *pPageType = PT_GRADIENT; @@ -250,11 +248,11 @@ int SvxGradientTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) long SvxGradientTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() { - // wird hier benutzt, um Aenderungen NICHT zu verlieren + // is used here in order to NOT lose changes XGradient aTmpGradient( aLbColorFrom.GetSelectEntryColor(), aLbColorTo.GetSelectEntryColor(), (XGradientStyle) aLbGradientType.GetSelectEntryPos(), - static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // sollte in Resource geaendert werden + static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // should be changed in resource (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterX.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterY.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrBorder.GetValue(), @@ -287,14 +285,14 @@ long SvxGradientTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() switch( nRet ) { - case RET_BTN_1: // Aendern + case RET_BTN_1: { ClickModifyHdl_Impl( this ); aGradient = pGradientList->GetGradient( nPos )->GetGradient(); } break; - case RET_BTN_2: // Hinzufuegen + case RET_BTN_2: { ClickAddHdl_Impl( this ); nPos = aLbGradients.GetSelectEntryPos(); @@ -322,7 +320,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxGradientTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) { if( *pDlgType == 0 && *pPageType == PT_GRADIENT && *pbAreaTP == sal_False ) { - // CheckChanges(); <-- doppelte Abfrage ? + // CheckChanges(); <-- duplicate inquiry ? XGradient* pXGradient = NULL; String aString; @@ -334,12 +332,12 @@ sal_Bool SvxGradientTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) } else - // Farbverlauf wurde (unbekannt) uebergeben + // gradient was passed (unidentified) { pXGradient = new XGradient( aLbColorFrom.GetSelectEntryColor(), aLbColorTo.GetSelectEntryColor(), (XGradientStyle) aLbGradientType.GetSelectEntryPos(), - static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // sollte in Resource geaendert werden + static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // should be changed in resource (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterX.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterY.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrBorder.GetValue(), @@ -362,7 +360,7 @@ void SvxGradientTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) // aLbGradients.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); ChangeGradientHdl_Impl( this ); - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine state of the buttons if( pGradientList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -394,18 +392,18 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxGradientTabPage, ModifiedHdl_Impl, void *, pControl ) XGradient aXGradient( aLbColorFrom.GetSelectEntryColor(), aLbColorTo.GetSelectEntryColor(), eXGS, - static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // sollte in Resource geaendert werden + static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // should be changed in resource (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterX.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterY.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrBorder.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrColorFrom.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrColorTo.GetValue() ); - // Enablen/Disablen von Controls + // enable/disable controls if( pControl == &aLbGradientType || pControl == this ) SetControlState_Impl( eXGS ); - // Anzeigen im XOutDev + // displaying in XOutDev rXFSet.Put( XFillGradientItem( String(), aXGradient ) ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -481,7 +479,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) XGradient aXGradient( aLbColorFrom.GetSelectEntryColor(), aLbColorTo.GetSelectEntryColor(), (XGradientStyle) aLbGradientType.GetSelectEntryPos(), - static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // sollte in Resource geaendert werden + static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // should be changed in resource (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterX.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterY.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrBorder.GetValue(), @@ -504,13 +502,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) } #endif - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnGradientListState |= CT_MODIFIED; ChangeGradientHdl_Impl( this ); } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pGradientList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -561,7 +558,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) XGradient aXGradient( aLbColorFrom.GetSelectEntryColor(), aLbColorTo.GetSelectEntryColor(), (XGradientStyle) aLbGradientType.GetSelectEntryPos(), - static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // sollte in Resource geaendert werden + static_cast(aMtrAngle.GetValue() * 10), // should be changed in resource (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterX.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrCenterY.GetValue(), (sal_uInt16) aMtrBorder.GetValue(), @@ -576,7 +573,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) aLbGradients.SelectEntryPos( nPos ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnGradientListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -613,11 +609,10 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickDeleteHdl_Impl) ChangeGradientHdl_Impl( this ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnGradientListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( !pGradientList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Disable(); @@ -663,7 +658,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) aPathURL.removeSegment(); aPathURL.removeFinalSlash(); - // Liste speichern + // save list XGradientListRef pGrdList = XPropertyList::CreatePropertyList( XGRADIENT_LIST, aPathURL.GetMainURL( INetURLObject::NO_DECODE ), pXPool )->AsGradientList(); pGrdList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); @@ -680,8 +675,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) pGradientList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (possibly cutting) the name + // and displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( ResId( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE, rMgr ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); @@ -693,9 +688,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) else aString += String(aURL.getBase()); - // Flag fuer gewechselt setzen *pnGradientListState |= CT_CHANGED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnGradientListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; LeaveWait(); } @@ -708,7 +701,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pGradientList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -758,8 +751,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) if( pGradientList->Save() ) { - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (possibly cutting) the name + // and displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); @@ -771,9 +764,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) else aString += String(aURL.getBase()); - // Flag fuer gespeichert setzen *pnGradientListState |= CT_SAVED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnGradientListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -821,8 +812,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ChangeGradientHdl_Impl) aLbGradientType.SelectEntryPos( sal::static_int_cast< sal_uInt16 >( eXGS ) ); - // Wenn der EIntrag nicht in der Listbox ist, werden die Farben - // temporaer hinzugenommen + // if the entry is not in the listbox ist, + // colors are added temporarily aLbColorFrom.SetNoSelection(); aLbColorFrom.SelectEntry( pGradient->GetStartColor() ); @@ -841,17 +832,17 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxGradientTabPage, ChangeGradientHdl_Impl) aLbColorTo.SelectEntry( pGradient->GetEndColor() ); } - aMtrAngle.SetValue( pGradient->GetAngle() / 10 ); // sollte in Resource geaendert werden + aMtrAngle.SetValue( pGradient->GetAngle() / 10 ); // should be changed in resource aMtrBorder.SetValue( pGradient->GetBorder() ); aMtrCenterX.SetValue( pGradient->GetXOffset() ); aMtrCenterY.SetValue( pGradient->GetYOffset() ); aMtrColorFrom.SetValue( pGradient->GetStartIntens() ); aMtrColorTo.SetValue( pGradient->GetEndIntens() ); - // Controls Disablen/Enablen + // disable/enable controls SetControlState_Impl( eXGS ); - // ItemSet fuellen und an aCtlPreview weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to aCtlPreview rXFSet.Put( XFillGradientItem( String(), *pGradient ) ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tphatch.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tphatch.cxx index b08c156e2af4..678763eeb6ff 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tphatch.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tphatch.cxx @@ -91,10 +91,10 @@ SvxHatchTabPage::SvxHatchTabPage { FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); - // Metrik einstellen + // adjust metric FieldUnit eFUnit = GetModuleFieldUnit( rInAttrs ); switch ( eFUnit ) @@ -107,12 +107,12 @@ SvxHatchTabPage::SvxHatchTabPage } SetFieldUnit( aMtrDistance, eFUnit ); - // PoolUnit ermitteln + // determine PoolUnit SfxItemPool* pPool = rOutAttrs.GetPool(); DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool?" ); ePoolUnit = pPool->GetMetric( SID_ATTR_FILL_HATCH ); - // Setzen des Output-Devices + // setting the output device rXFSet.Put( aXFStyleItem ); rXFSet.Put( aXHatchItem ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -149,10 +149,7 @@ SvxHatchTabPage::SvxHatchTabPage void SvxHatchTabPage::Construct() { - // Farbtabelle aLbLineColor.Fill( pColorList ); - - // Schraffurentabelle aLbHatchings.Fill( pHatchingList ); } @@ -163,7 +160,7 @@ void SvxHatchTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) sal_uInt16 nPos; sal_uInt16 nCount; - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { *pbAreaTP = sal_False; @@ -182,7 +179,7 @@ void SvxHatchTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aLbLineColor.Fill( pColorList ); nCount = aLbLineColor.GetEntryCount(); if( nCount == 0 ) - ; // Dieser Fall sollte nicht auftreten + ; // this case should not occur else if( nCount <= nPos ) aLbLineColor.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); else @@ -191,8 +188,8 @@ void SvxHatchTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) ModifiedHdl_Impl( this ); } - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (possibly cutting) the name + // and displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pHatchingList->GetPath() ); @@ -211,7 +208,7 @@ void SvxHatchTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { aLbHatchings.SelectEntryPos( *pPos ); } - // Farben koennten geloescht worden sein + // colors could have been deleted ChangeHatchHdl_Impl( this ); *pPageType = PT_HATCH; @@ -266,13 +263,13 @@ long SvxHatchTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() switch( nRet ) { - case RET_BTN_1: // Aendern + case RET_BTN_1: { ClickModifyHdl_Impl( this ); } break; - case RET_BTN_2: // Hinzufuegen + case RET_BTN_2: { ClickAddHdl_Impl( this ); } @@ -294,11 +291,11 @@ long SvxHatchTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() sal_Bool SvxHatchTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 && *pbAreaTP == sal_False ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 && *pbAreaTP == sal_False ) // area dialog { if( *pPageType == PT_HATCH ) { - // CheckChanges(); <-- doppelte Abfrage ? + // CheckChanges(); <-- duplicate inquiry ? XHatch* pXHatch = NULL; String aString; @@ -308,7 +305,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxHatchTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) pXHatch = new XHatch( pHatchingList->GetHatch( nPos )->GetHatch() ); aString = aLbHatchings.GetSelectEntry(); } - // Farbverlauf wurde (unbekannt) uebergeben + // gradient has been (unidentifiedly) passed else { pXHatch = new XHatch( aLbLineColor.GetSelectEntryColor(), @@ -332,7 +329,7 @@ void SvxHatchTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) { ChangeHatchHdl_Impl( this ); - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pHatchingList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -366,7 +363,6 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxHatchTabPage, ModifiedHdl_Impl, void *, p ) { if( p == &aMtrAngle ) { - // Setzen des Winkels im AngleControl switch( aMtrAngle.GetValue() ) { case 135: aCtlAngle.SetActualRP( RP_LT ); break; @@ -426,8 +422,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ChangeHatchHdl_Impl) { aLbLineType.SelectEntryPos( sal::static_int_cast< sal_uInt16 >( pHatch->GetHatchStyle() ) ); - // Wenn der Eintrag nicht in der Listbox ist, wird die Farbe - // temporaer hinzugenommen + // if the entry is not in the listbox + // the color is added temporarily aLbLineColor.SetNoSelection(); aLbLineColor.SelectEntry( pHatch->GetColor() ); if( aLbLineColor.GetSelectEntryCount() == 0 ) @@ -438,7 +434,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ChangeHatchHdl_Impl) SetMetricValue( aMtrDistance, pHatch->GetDistance(), ePoolUnit ); aMtrAngle.SetValue( pHatch->GetAngle() / 10 ); - // Setzen des Winkels im AngleControl switch( aMtrAngle.GetValue() ) { case 135: aCtlAngle.SetActualRP( RP_LT ); break; @@ -452,7 +447,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ChangeHatchHdl_Impl) default: aCtlAngle.SetActualRP( RP_MM ); break; } - // ItemSet fuellen und an aCtlPreview weiterleiten + // fill ItemSet and pass it on to aCtlPreview rXFSet.Put( XFillHatchItem( String(), *pHatch ) ); aCtlPreview.SetAttributes( aXFillAttr.GetItemSet() ); @@ -552,13 +547,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) } #endif - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnHatchingListState |= CT_MODIFIED; ChangeHatchHdl_Impl( this ); } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pHatchingList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -618,14 +612,13 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) aLbHatchings.SelectEntryPos( nPos ); - // Werte sichern fuer Changes-Erkennung ( -> Methode ) + // save values for changes recognition (-> method) aMtrDistance.SaveValue(); aMtrAngle.SaveValue(); aLbLineType.SaveValue(); aLbLineColor.SaveValue(); aLbHatchings.SaveValue(); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnHatchingListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -661,11 +654,10 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickDeleteHdl_Impl) ChangeHatchHdl_Impl( this ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnHatchingListState |= CT_MODIFIED; } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( !pHatchingList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Disable(); @@ -723,8 +715,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) pHatchingList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (and possibly cutting) the name + // and displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( ResId( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE, rMgr ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); @@ -736,9 +728,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) else aString += String(aURL.getBase()); - // Flag fuer gewechselt setzen *pnHatchingListState |= CT_CHANGED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnHatchingListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -747,7 +737,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if ( pHatchingList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -797,8 +787,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) if( pHatchingList->Save() ) { - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (and possibly cutting) the name + // and displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); @@ -810,9 +800,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxHatchTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) else aString += String(aURL.getBase()); - // Flag fuer gespeichert setzen *pnHatchingListState |= CT_SAVED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnHatchingListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tpline.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tpline.cxx index 2fb8f898367d..05e9133f3b09 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tpline.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tpline.cxx @@ -187,7 +187,7 @@ SvxLineTabPage::SvxLineTabPage SetFieldUnit( aMtrStartWidth, eFUnit ); SetFieldUnit( aMtrEndWidth, eFUnit ); - // PoolUnit ermitteln + // determine PoolUnit SfxItemPool* pPool = rOutAttrs.GetPool(); DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Where is the pool?" ); ePoolUnit = pPool->GetMetric( SID_ATTR_LINE_WIDTH ); @@ -1592,7 +1592,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineTabPage, ChangeEdgeStyleHdl_Impl) IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineTabPage, ClickInvisibleHdl_Impl) { - if( aLbLineStyle.GetSelectEntryPos() == 0 ) // unsichtbar + if( aLbLineStyle.GetSelectEntryPos() == 0 ) // invisible { aFtColor.Disable(); if(!bSymbols) diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tplnedef.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tplnedef.cxx index 962caebfd872..72563d2de5c6 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tplnedef.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tplnedef.cxx @@ -105,10 +105,10 @@ SvxLineDefTabPage::SvxLineDefTabPage FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); - // Metrik einstellen + // adjust metric eFUnit = GetModuleFieldUnit( rInAttrs ); switch ( eFUnit ) @@ -123,7 +123,7 @@ SvxLineDefTabPage::SvxLineDefTabPage SetFieldUnit( aMtrLength1, eFUnit ); SetFieldUnit( aMtrLength2, eFUnit ); - // PoolUnit ermitteln + // determine PoolUnit SfxItemPool* pPool = rOutAttrs.GetPool(); DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool?" ); ePoolUnit = pPool->GetMetric( SID_ATTR_LINE_WIDTH ); @@ -151,11 +151,11 @@ SvxLineDefTabPage::SvxLineDefTabPage aLbLineStyles.SetSelectHdl( LINK( this, SvxLineDefTabPage, SelectLinestyleHdl_Impl ) ); - // Absolut (in mm) oder Relativ (in %) + // absolute (in mm) or relative (in %) aCbxSynchronize.SetClickHdl( LINK( this, SvxLineDefTabPage, ChangeMetricHdl_Impl ) ); - // Wenn sich etwas aendert, muss Preview upgedatet werden werden + // preview must be updated when there's something changed Link aLink = LINK( this, SvxLineDefTabPage, SelectTypeHdl_Impl ); aLbType1.SetSelectHdl( aLink ); aLbType2.SetSelectHdl( aLink ); @@ -178,7 +178,6 @@ SvxLineDefTabPage::SvxLineDefTabPage void SvxLineDefTabPage::Construct() { - // Linienstile aLbLineStyles.Fill( pDashList ); } @@ -186,9 +185,9 @@ void SvxLineDefTabPage::Construct() void SvxLineDefTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { - // ActivatePage() wird aufgerufen bevor der Dialog PageCreated() erhaelt !!! + // ActivatePage() is called before the dialog receives PageCreated() !!! if( pDashList.is() ) { if( *pPageType == 1 && @@ -196,11 +195,11 @@ void SvxLineDefTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) { aLbLineStyles.SelectEntryPos( *pPosDashLb ); } - // Damit evtl. vorhandener Linestyle verworfen wird + // so that a possibly existing line style is discarded SelectLinestyleHdl_Impl( this ); - // Ermitteln (evtl. abschneiden) des Namens und in - // der GroupBox darstellen + // determining (and possibly cutting) the name + // and displaying it in the GroupBox String aString( CUI_RES( RID_SVXSTR_TABLE ) ); aString.AppendAscii( RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( ": " ) ); INetURLObject aURL( pDashList->GetPath() ); @@ -229,7 +228,7 @@ int SvxLineDefTabPage::DeactivatePage( SfxItemSet* _pSet ) void SvxLineDefTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() { - // wird hier benutzt, um Aenderungen NICHT zu verlieren + // is here used to NOT lose changes //XDashStyle eXDS; if( aNumFldNumber1.GetText() != aNumFldNumber1.GetSavedValue() || @@ -258,13 +257,13 @@ void SvxLineDefTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() switch( nRet ) { - case RET_BTN_1: // Aendern + case RET_BTN_1: { ClickModifyHdl_Impl( this ); } break; - case RET_BTN_2: // Hinzufuegen + case RET_BTN_2: { ClickAddHdl_Impl( this ); } @@ -289,7 +288,7 @@ void SvxLineDefTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() sal_Bool SvxLineDefTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Linien-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // line dialog { if( *pPageType == 2 ) { @@ -334,7 +333,7 @@ void SvxLineDefTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } SelectLinestyleHdl_Impl( NULL ); - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pDashList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -379,9 +378,9 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxLineDefTabPage, SelectLinestyleHdl_Impl, void *, p ) aCtlPreview.Invalidate(); - // Wird erst hier gesetzt, um den Style nur dann zu uebernehmen, - // wenn in der ListBox ein Eintrag ausgewaehlt wurde - // Wenn ueber Reset() gerufen wurde ist p == NULL + // Is not set before, in order to take the new style + // only if there was an entry selected in the ListBox. + // If it was called via Reset(), then p is == NULL if( p ) *pPageType = 2; } @@ -448,7 +447,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxLineDefTabPage, ChangeMetricHdl_Impl, void *, p ) { long nTmp1, nTmp2, nTmp3; - // Wurde ueber Control geaendert + // was changed with Control if( p ) { nTmp1 = GetCoreValue( aMtrLength1, ePoolUnit ) * XOUT_WIDTH / 100; @@ -465,7 +464,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxLineDefTabPage, ChangeMetricHdl_Impl, void *, p ) aMtrLength2.SetDecimalDigits( 2 ); aMtrDistance.SetDecimalDigits( 2 ); - // Metrik einstellen + // adjust metric aMtrLength1.SetUnit( eFUnit ); aMtrLength2.SetUnit( eFUnit ); aMtrDistance.SetUnit( eFUnit ); @@ -478,7 +477,7 @@ IMPL_LINK( SvxLineDefTabPage, ChangeMetricHdl_Impl, void *, p ) { long nTmp1, nTmp2, nTmp3; - // Wurde ueber Control geaendert + // was changed with Control if( p ) { nTmp1 = GetCoreValue( aMtrLength1, ePoolUnit ) * 100 / XOUT_WIDTH; @@ -602,12 +601,11 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) aLbLineStyles.SelectEntryPos( aLbLineStyles.GetEntryCount() - 1 ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnDashListState |= CT_MODIFIED; *pPageType = 2; - // Werte sichern fuer Changes-Erkennung ( -> Methode ) + // save values for changes recognition (-> method) aNumFldNumber1.SaveValue(); aMtrLength1.SaveValue(); aLbType1.SaveValue(); @@ -625,7 +623,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) } delete( pDlg ); - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if ( pDashList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -683,12 +681,11 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) aLbLineStyles.SelectEntryPos( nPos ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnDashListState |= CT_MODIFIED; *pPageType = 2; - // Werte sichern fuer Changes-Erkennung ( -> Methode ) + // save values for changes recognition (-> method) aNumFldNumber1.SaveValue(); aMtrLength1.SaveValue(); aLbType1.SaveValue(); @@ -727,16 +724,15 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickDeleteHdl_Impl) aLbLineStyles.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); SelectLinestyleHdl_Impl( this ); - *pPageType = 0; // Style soll nicht uebernommen werden + *pPageType = 0; // style should not be taken - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnDashListState |= CT_MODIFIED; ChangePreviewHdl_Impl( this ); } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if ( !pDashList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Disable(); @@ -795,9 +791,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) pDashList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); - // Flag fuer gewechselt setzen *pnDashListState |= CT_CHANGED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnDashListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -807,7 +801,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if ( pDashList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -857,9 +851,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineDefTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) if( pDashList->Save() ) { - // Flag fuer gespeichert setzen *pnDashListState |= CT_SAVED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnDashListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -918,7 +910,7 @@ void SvxLineDefTabPage::FillDialog_Impl() ChangeMetricHdl_Impl( NULL ); - // Werte sichern fuer Changes-Erkennung ( -> Methode ) + // save values for changes recognition (-> method) aNumFldNumber1.SaveValue(); aMtrLength1.SaveValue(); aLbType1.SaveValue(); diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tplneend.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tplneend.cxx index 16f7f3b2a5dd..ef445d8f5dc1 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tplneend.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tplneend.cxx @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ SvxLineEndDefTabPage::SvxLineEndDefTabPage { FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); rXLSet.Put( aXLStyle ); @@ -163,9 +163,9 @@ void SvxLineEndDefTabPage::Construct() void SvxLineEndDefTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Flaechen-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // area dialog { - // ActivatePage() wird aufgerufen bevor der Dialog PageCreated() erhaelt !!! + // ActivatePage() is called before the dialog receives PageCreated() !!! if( pLineEndList.is() ) { if( *pPosLineEndLb != LISTBOX_ENTRY_NOTFOUND ) @@ -224,7 +224,7 @@ void SvxLineEndDefTabPage::CheckChanges_Impl() sal_Bool SvxLineEndDefTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rSet ) { - if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // Linien-Dialog + if( *pDlgType == 0 ) // line dialog { if( *pPageType == 3 ) { @@ -264,7 +264,7 @@ void SvxLineEndDefTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) aCtlPreview.Invalidate(); } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( pLineEndList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -307,8 +307,8 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, SelectLineEndHdl_Impl) aCtlPreview.Invalidate(); - // Wird erst hier gesetzt, um den Style nur dann zu uebernehmen, - // wenn in der ListBox ein Eintrag ausgewaehlt wurde + // Is not set before, in order to only take the new style, + // if there is an entry selected in the ListBox *pPageType = 3; } return( 0L ); @@ -336,12 +336,12 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) long nCount = pLineEndList->Count(); sal_Bool bDifferent = sal_True; - // Pruefen, ob Name schon vorhanden ist + // check whether the name is existing already for ( long i = 0; i < nCount && bDifferent; i++ ) if ( aName == pLineEndList->GetLineEnd( i )->GetName() ) bDifferent = sal_False; - // Wenn ja, wird wiederholt ein neuer Name angefordert + // if yes, repeat and demand a new name if ( !bDifferent ) { WarningBox aWarningBox( GetParentDialog(), WinBits( WB_OK ), @@ -374,7 +374,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) delete( pDlg ); } - // Wenn nicht vorhanden, wird Eintrag aufgenommen + // if not existing, enter the entry if( bDifferent ) { XLineEndEntry* pEntry = pLineEndList->GetLineEnd( nPos ); @@ -385,7 +385,6 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickModifyHdl_Impl) aLbLineEnds.Modify( pEntry, nPos, pLineEndList->GetBitmap( nPos ) ); aLbLineEnds.SelectEntryPos( nPos ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnLineEndListState |= CT_MODIFIED; *pPageType = 3; @@ -417,20 +416,19 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) pNewObj = pConvPolyObj = pPolyObj->ConvertToPolyObj( sal_True, sal_False ); if( !pNewObj || !pNewObj->ISA( SdrPathObj ) ) - return( 0L ); // Abbruch, zusaetzliche Sicherheit, die bei - // Gruppenobjekten aber nichts bringt. + return( 0L ); // cancel, additional safety, which + // has no use for group objects though. } - else return( 0L ); // Abbruch + else return( 0L ); // cancel } basegfx::B2DPolyPolygon aNewPolyPolygon(((SdrPathObj*)pNewObj)->GetPathPoly()); basegfx::B2DRange aNewRange(basegfx::tools::getRange(aNewPolyPolygon)); - // Normalisieren + // normalize aNewPolyPolygon.transform(basegfx::tools::createTranslateB2DHomMatrix( -aNewRange.getMinX(), -aNewRange.getMinY())); - // Loeschen des angelegten PolyObjektes SdrObject::Free( pConvPolyObj ); XLineEndEntry* pEntry; @@ -482,11 +480,10 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) pLineEndList->Insert( pEntry, nLineEndCount ); Bitmap* pBitmap = pLineEndList->GetBitmap( nLineEndCount ); - // Zur ListBox hinzufuegen + // add to the ListBox aLbLineEnds.Append( pEntry, pBitmap ); aLbLineEnds.SelectEntryPos( aLbLineEnds.GetEntryCount() - 1 ); - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnLineEndListState |= CT_MODIFIED; SelectLineEndHdl_Impl( this ); @@ -503,7 +500,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickAddHdl_Impl) else aBtnAdd.Disable(); - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if ( pLineEndList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -531,15 +528,14 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickDeleteHdl_Impl) aLbLineEnds.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); SelectLineEndHdl_Impl( this ); - *pPageType = 0; // LineEnd soll nicht uebernommen werden + *pPageType = 0; // LineEnd shall not be taken over - // Flag fuer modifiziert setzen *pnLineEndListState |= CT_MODIFIED; ChangePreviewHdl_Impl( this ); } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if( !pLineEndList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Disable(); @@ -596,9 +592,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) pLineEndList->SetName( aURL.getName() ); - // Flag fuer gewechselt setzen *pnLineEndListState |= CT_CHANGED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnLineEndListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else @@ -607,7 +601,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickLoadHdl_Impl) } } - // Status der Buttons ermitteln + // determine button state if ( pLineEndList->Count() ) { aBtnModify.Enable(); @@ -657,9 +651,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxLineEndDefTabPage, ClickSaveHdl_Impl) if( pLineEndList->Save() ) { - // Flag fuer gespeichert setzen *pnLineEndListState |= CT_SAVED; - // Flag fuer modifiziert entfernen *pnLineEndListState &= ~CT_MODIFIED; } else diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/tpshadow.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/tpshadow.cxx index 11973094b84e..1105bae808a8 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/tpshadow.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/tpshadow.cxx @@ -80,10 +80,10 @@ SvxShadowTabPage::SvxShadowTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs { FreeResource(); - // diese Page braucht ExchangeSupport + // this page needs ExchangeSupport SetExchangeSupport(); - // Metrik einstellen + // adjust metric FieldUnit eFUnit = GetModuleFieldUnit( rInAttrs ); switch ( eFUnit ) @@ -96,12 +96,12 @@ SvxShadowTabPage::SvxShadowTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs } SetFieldUnit( aMtrDistance, eFUnit ); - // PoolUnit ermitteln + // determine PoolUnit SfxItemPool* pPool = rOutAttrs.GetPool(); DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "Wo ist der Pool?" ); ePoolUnit = pPool->GetMetric( SDRATTR_SHADOWXDIST ); - // Setzen des Output-Devices + // setting the output device XFillStyle eXFS = XFILL_SOLID; if( rOutAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_FILLSTYLE ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ SvxShadowTabPage::SvxShadowTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs Get( GetWhich( XATTR_FILLSTYLE ) ) ).GetValue() ); switch( eXFS ) { - //case XFILL_NONE: --> NICHTS + //case XFILL_NONE: --> NOTHING case XFILL_SOLID: if( SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE != rOutAttrs.GetItemState( XATTR_FILLCOLOR ) ) @@ -183,7 +183,6 @@ SvxShadowTabPage::SvxShadowTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSet& rInAttrs void SvxShadowTabPage::Construct() { - // Farbtabelle fuellen aLbShadowColor.Fill( pColorList ); if( bDisable ) @@ -241,7 +240,7 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::ActivatePage( const SfxItemSet& rSet ) aLbShadowColor.Fill( pColorList ); nCount = aLbShadowColor.GetEntryCount(); if( nCount == 0 ) - ; // Dieser Fall sollte nicht auftreten + ; // this case should not occur else if( nCount <= nPos ) aLbShadowColor.SelectEntryPos( 0 ); else @@ -273,7 +272,6 @@ sal_Bool SvxShadowTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) if( !bDisable ) { - // Schatten TriState eState = aTsbShowShadow.GetState(); if( eState != aTsbShowShadow.GetSavedValue() ) { @@ -286,9 +284,9 @@ sal_Bool SvxShadowTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } } - // Schatten-Entfernung - // Etwas umstaendliche Abfrage, ob etwas geaendert wurde, - // da Items nicht direkt auf Controls abbildbar sind + // shadow removal + // a bit intricate inquiry whether there was something changed, + // as the items can't be displayed directly on controls sal_Int32 nX = 0L, nY = 0L; sal_Int32 nXY = GetCoreValue( aMtrDistance, ePoolUnit ); @@ -305,15 +303,15 @@ sal_Bool SvxShadowTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) case RP_MM: break; } - // Wenn die Werte des Schattenabstanden==SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE und der angezeigte - // String im entspr. MetricField=="", dann w�rde der Vergleich zw. alten und - // neuen Distance-Werte ein falsches Ergebnis liefern, da in so einem Fall die - // neuen Distance-Werte den Default-Werten des MetricField entspr�chen !!!! + // If the values of the shadow distances==SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE and the displayed + // string in the respective MetricField=="", then the comparison of the old + // and the new distance values would return a wrong result because in such a + // case the new distance values would matche the default values of the MetricField !!!! if ( !aMtrDistance.IsEmptyFieldValue() || rOutAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWXDIST ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE || rOutAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWYDIST ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { - sal_Int32 nOldX = 9876543; // Unmoeglicher Wert, entspr. DontCare + sal_Int32 nOldX = 9876543; // impossible value, so DontCare sal_Int32 nOldY = 9876543; if( rOutAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWXDIST ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE && rOutAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWYDIST ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) @@ -356,7 +354,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxShadowTabPage::FillItemSet( SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) } } - // Transparenz + // transparency sal_uInt16 nVal = (sal_uInt16)aMtrTransparent.GetValue(); if( nVal != (sal_uInt16)aMtrTransparent.GetSavedValue().ToInt32() ) { @@ -381,10 +379,10 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) { if( !bDisable ) { - // Alle Objekte koennen einen Schatten besitzen - // z.Z. gibt es nur 8 m�gliche Positionen den Schatten zu setzen + // all objects can have a shadow + // at the moment there are only 8 possible positions where a shadow can be set - // Ist Schatten gesetzt? + // has a shadow been set? if( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOW ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { aTsbShowShadow.EnableTriState( sal_False ); @@ -399,8 +397,8 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) else aTsbShowShadow.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); - // Entfernung (nur 8 moegliche Positionen), deshalb - // wird nur ein Item ausgewertet + // distance (only 8 possible positions), + // so there is only one item evaluated if( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWXDIST ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE && rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWYDIST ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) @@ -413,12 +411,12 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) else SetMetricValue( aMtrDistance, nY < 0L ? -nY : nY, ePoolUnit ); - // Setzen des Schatten-Controls + // setting the shadow control if ( nX < 0L && nY < 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_LT ); else if( nX == 0L && nY < 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_MT ); else if( nX > 0L && nY < 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_RT ); else if( nX < 0L && nY == 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_LM ); - // Mittelpunkt gibt es nicht mehr + // there's no center point anymore else if( nX == 0L && nY == 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_RB ); else if( nX > 0L && nY == 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_RM ); else if( nX < 0L && nY > 0L ) aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_LB ); @@ -441,14 +439,13 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) SetMetricValue( aMtrDistance, nY < 0L ? -nY : nY, ePoolUnit ); } - // Tristate, z.B. mehrer Objekte wurden markiert, wovon einige einen Schatten besitzen, einige nicht. - // Der anzuzeigende Text des MetricFields wird auf "" gesetzt und dient in der Methode FillItemSet - // als Erkennungszeichen daf�r, das der Distance-Wert NICHT ver�ndert wurde !!!! + // Tristate, e. g. multiple objects have been marked of which some have a shadow and some don't. + // The text (which shall be displayed) of the MetricFields is set to "" and serves as an + // identification in the method FillItemSet for the fact that the distance value was NOT changed !!!! aMtrDistance.SetText( String() ); aCtlPosition.SetActualRP( RP_MM ); } - // SchattenFarbe: if( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWCOLOR ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { aLbShadowColor.SelectEntry( ( ( const SdrShadowColorItem& ) rAttrs.Get( SDRATTR_SHADOWCOLOR ) ).GetColorValue() ); @@ -456,7 +453,6 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) else aLbShadowColor.SetNoSelection(); - // Transparenz if( rAttrs.GetItemState( SDRATTR_SHADOWTRANSPARENCE ) != SFX_ITEM_DONTCARE ) { sal_uInt16 nTransp = ( ( const SdrShadowTransparenceItem& ) rAttrs.Get( SDRATTR_SHADOWTRANSPARENCE ) ).GetValue(); @@ -465,7 +461,6 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& rAttrs ) else aMtrTransparent.SetText( String() ); - // Werte sichern //aCtlPosition aMtrDistance.SaveValue(); aLbShadowColor.SaveValue(); @@ -548,7 +543,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxShadowTabPage, ModifyShadowHdl_Impl) XFillTransparenceItem aItem( nVal ); rXFSet.Put( XFillTransparenceItem( aItem ) ); - // Schatten-Entfernung + // shadow removal sal_Int32 nX = 0L, nY = 0L; sal_Int32 nXY = GetCoreValue( aMtrDistance, ePoolUnit ); switch( aCtlPosition.GetActualRP() ) @@ -579,7 +574,7 @@ void SvxShadowTabPage::PointChanged( Window* pWindow, RECT_POINT eRcPt ) { eRP = eRcPt; - // Schatten neu zeichnen + // repaint shadow ModifyShadowHdl_Impl( pWindow ); } diff --git a/cui/source/tabpages/transfrm.cxx b/cui/source/tabpages/transfrm.cxx index 03b5e34d0f22..46fe07e311e3 100644 --- a/cui/source/tabpages/transfrm.cxx +++ b/cui/source/tabpages/transfrm.cxx @@ -50,7 +50,7 @@ #include #include -// Toleranz fuer WorkingArea +// tolerance for WorkingArea #define DIFF 1000 // static ---------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -114,7 +114,7 @@ void lcl_ScaleRect(basegfx::B2DRange& rRange, const Fraction aUIScale) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Konstruktor des Tab-Dialogs: Fuegt die Seiten zum Dialog hinzu +|* constructor of the tab dialog: adds the pages to the dialog |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -216,8 +216,8 @@ void SvxTransformTabDialog::SetValidateFramePosLink(const Link& rLink) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum Aendern der Position des Drehwinkels und des Drehwinkels -|* der Grafikobjekte +|* dialog for changing the positions of the rotation +|* angle and the rotation angle of the graphic objects |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -513,7 +513,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxAngleTabPage, ModifiedHdl) /************************************************************************* |* -|* Dialog zum Aendern des Eckenradius und zum Schraegstellen +|* dialog for changing slant and corner radius |* \************************************************************************/ @@ -583,7 +583,7 @@ sal_Bool SvxSlantTabPage::FillItemSet(SfxItemSet& rAttrs) if( bModified ) { - // Referenzpunkt setzen + // set reference points // #75897# Rectangle aObjectRect(pView->GetAllMarkedRect()); pView->GetSdrPageView()->LogicToPagePos(aObjectRect); @@ -604,7 +604,7 @@ void SvxSlantTabPage::Reset(const SfxItemSet& rAttrs) // if the view has selected objects, items with SFX_ITEM_DEFAULT need to be disabled const SfxPoolItem* pItem; - // Eckenradius + // corner radius if(!pView->IsEdgeRadiusAllowed()) { aFlRadius.Disable(); @@ -630,7 +630,7 @@ void SvxSlantTabPage::Reset(const SfxItemSet& rAttrs) aMtrRadius.SaveValue(); - // Schraegstellen: Winkel + // slant: angle if( !pView->IsShearAllowed() ) { aFlAngle.Disable(); @@ -753,7 +753,7 @@ SvxPositionSizeTabPage::SvxPositionSizeTabPage( Window* pParent, const SfxItemSe DBG_ASSERT( pPool, "no pool (!)" ); mePoolUnit = pPool->GetMetric( SID_ATTR_TRANSFORM_POS_X ); - meRP = RP_LT; // s.o. + meRP = RP_LT; // see above maMtrWidth.SetModifyHdl( LINK( this, SvxPositionSizeTabPage, ChangeWidthHdl ) ); maMtrHeight.SetModifyHdl( LINK( this, SvxPositionSizeTabPage, ChangeHeightHdl ) ); @@ -1089,7 +1089,7 @@ void SvxPositionSizeTabPage::Reset( const SfxItemSet& ) else maTsbAutoGrowHeight.SetState( STATE_DONTKNOW ); - // Ist Abgleich gesetzt? + // Is matching set? String aStr = GetUserData(); maCbxScale.Check( (sal_Bool)aStr.ToInt32() ); @@ -1679,7 +1679,7 @@ IMPL_LINK_NOARG(SvxPositionSizeTabPage, ClickAutoHdl) void SvxPositionSizeTabPage::FillUserData() { - // Abgleich wird in der Ini-Datei festgehalten + // matching is saved in the Ini-file UniString aStr = UniString::CreateFromInt32( (sal_Int32) maCbxScale.IsChecked() ); SetUserData( aStr ); } -- cgit